blob: 7293a3cb43c6f54b6f5f28baf3d8d3ec37d1bc71 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreau37033252022-05-14 16:05:50 +02006 2022/05/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100729before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
730use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
731next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
732existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200733
734 Example:
735
736 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
737
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100738 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200739
740 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
743file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200744
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
746 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
747
748* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
749 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
750 directory.
751
752* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 processes, separated by semicolons.
756
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500757* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200758 CLI, separated by semicolons.
759
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200760In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
761regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
762only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
763
764* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
765
766* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
767 starting at one.
768
769* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
770 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
771 first section.
772
773These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
774if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
775section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
776"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
777proxies.
778
779This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
780logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
781to name some config objects like servers for example.
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200784
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100785
7862.4. Conditional blocks
787-----------------------
788
789It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
790some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
791ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
792configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
793versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
794preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
795text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
796lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
797switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
798are defined to form conditional blocks:
799
800 - .if <condition>
801 - .elif <condition>
802 - .else
803 - .endif
804
805The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
806as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
807matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
808there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
809only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
810".elif" of a block.
811
812Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
813ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
814as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
815
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200816Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
817See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
818
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200819The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
820expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100821
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
823 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200824 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200825 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530826 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
827 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200828 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
829 from left to right until one returns false
830 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
831 from right to left until one returns true
832
833Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
834operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200835
836The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
837
838 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
839 exists, regardless of its contents
840
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200841 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
842 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
843 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
844
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200845 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
846 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
847
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200848 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
849 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
850 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
851 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
852
853 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
854 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
855 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
856 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
857
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200858Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200860 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
861 listen mwcli_px
862 bind :1111
863 ...
864 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
867 bind :80
868 .endif
869
870 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200871 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200872 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200873 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200874 .endif
875
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200876 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200877 bind :443 ssl crt ...
878 .endif
879
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200880 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
881 profiling.memory on
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200884 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
885 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
886 .endif
887
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200888Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100889
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200890 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100891 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
892 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
893 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
894
895Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
896"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
897fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
898provide advice to the user.
899
900Example:
901
902 .if "${A}"
903 .if "${B}"
904 .notice "A=1, B=1"
905 .elif "${C}"
906 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
907 .elif "${D}"
908 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
909 .else
910 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
911 .endif
912 .else
913 .notice "A=0"
914 .endif
915
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200916 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
917 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
918
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100919
9202.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200921----------------
922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100923Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
925otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
926numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
927for every keyword. Supported units are :
928
929 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
930 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
931 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
932 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
933 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
934 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
935
936
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009372.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200938-------------
939
940 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
941 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
942 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
943 global
944 daemon
945 maxconn 256
946
947 defaults
948 mode http
949 timeout connect 5000ms
950 timeout client 50000ms
951 timeout server 50000ms
952
953 frontend http-in
954 bind *:80
955 default_backend servers
956
957 backend servers
958 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
959
960
961 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
962 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
963 global
964 daemon
965 maxconn 256
966
967 defaults
968 mode http
969 timeout connect 5000ms
970 timeout client 50000ms
971 timeout server 50000ms
972
973 listen http-in
974 bind *:80
975 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
976
977
978Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
979
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100980 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200981
982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009833. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984--------------------
985
986Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
987are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
988of them have command-line equivalents.
989
990The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
991
992 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +0200995 - cluster-secret
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001007 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001008 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001009 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001011 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001012 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1013 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1014 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1015 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001016 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001017 - h1-case-adjust
1018 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001019 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001020 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001021 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001022 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001023 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001026 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001028 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001029 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001030 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001031 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001032 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001033 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001034 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001035 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001036 - presetenv
1037 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - uid
1039 - ulimit-n
1040 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001041 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001042 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001043 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001044 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001046 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001047 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001048 - ssl-default-bind-options
1049 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001050 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001051 - ssl-default-server-options
1052 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001053 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001054 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001055 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001056 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001057 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001058 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001059 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001060 - 51degrees-data-file
1061 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001062 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001063 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001064 - wurfl-data-file
1065 - wurfl-information-list
1066 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001067 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001068 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001071 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001072 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001074 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001075 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001076 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001077 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001078 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001079 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001080 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001081 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001082 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083 - noepoll
1084 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001085 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001087 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001088 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001089 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001090 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001091 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001092 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001093 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001094 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001095 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001096 - tune.buffers.limit
1097 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001098 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001099 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001100 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001101 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001102 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001103 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001104 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001105 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001106 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001107 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001108 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001109 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001110 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001111 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1112 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001113 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001114 - tune.maxaccept
1115 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001116 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001117 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001118 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001119 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1120 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02001121 - tune.quic.conn-buf-limit
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001122 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1123 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001124 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001125 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001126 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001127 - tune.sndbuf.client
1128 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001129 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001130 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1131 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001132 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001133 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1134 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001135 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001136 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001137 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1138 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001139 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001140 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001141 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1142 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1143 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001144 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1145 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001146
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001149 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150
1151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011523.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001153------------------------------------
1154
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001155ca-base <dir>
1156 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001157 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1158 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1159 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161chroot <jail dir>
1162 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1163 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1164 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1165 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1166 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001167 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001168
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001169cluster-secret <secret>
1170 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1171 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1172 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1173 this process. If you do not set this parameter, the stateless reset QUIC
1174 feature will be silently disabled.
1175
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001176close-spread-time <time>
1177 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1178 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1179 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1180 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1181 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1182 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1183 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1184 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001185 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1186 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1187 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1188 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1189 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001190
1191 Arguments :
1192 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001193 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1194 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001195
1196 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1197 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1198 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1199
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001200 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001201
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001202cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001203 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001204 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1205 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1206 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1207 set. These sets have the format
1208
1209 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1210
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001211 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1212 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001213 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001214 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001215 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1216 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001217 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1218 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1219 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1220 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1221 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1222 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1223 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1224 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1225 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1226 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001227
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001228 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1229 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1230 on the machine's word size.
1231
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001232 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001233 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1234 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1235 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1236 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1237 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1238 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001239
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001240 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1241 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1242 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1243 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001244
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001245 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001246 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1247 # first 4 CPUs
1248
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001249 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1250 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001251 # word size.
1252
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001253 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1254 # and so on.
1255 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1256 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1257 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1258
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001259 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1260 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1261 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1262 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001263
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001264 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1265 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1266 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001267
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001268crt-base <dir>
1269 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001270 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1271 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001272
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001273daemon
1274 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1275 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001276 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1277 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001278
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001279default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001280 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001281 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1282 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1283 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1284 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1285 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1286 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1287 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1288 not start with a slash ('/'):
1289 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1290 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1291
1292 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1293 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1294 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1295 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1296 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1297 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1298 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1299 each of them.
1300
1301 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1302 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1303 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1304 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1305 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1306 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1307 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1308 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1309
1310 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1311 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001312 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001313 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1314 made easily relocatable.
1315
1316 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1317 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1318 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1319 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1320 consistent across all configuration files.
1321
1322 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1323 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1324 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1325 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1326 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1327 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1328 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1329 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1330
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001331deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1332 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001333 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001334
1335deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001336 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001337 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1338
1339deviceatlas-separator <char>
1340 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1341 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1342
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001343deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001344 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1345 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1346 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001347
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001348expose-experimental-directives
1349 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1350 the config file will be rejected.
1351
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001352external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001353 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1354 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001355 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1356 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1357 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1358 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1359 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001360
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001361fd-hard-limit <number>
1362 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1363 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1364 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1365 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1366 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1367 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1368 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1369 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1370 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1371 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1372 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1373 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1374
1375 global
1376 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1377 fd-hard-limit 50000
1378
1379 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1380
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001381gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001382 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001383 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1384 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001385 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001386 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001388
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001389grace <time>
1390 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1391
1392 Arguments :
1393 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1394 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1395 soft-stop operation.
1396
1397 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1398 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1399 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1400 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1401 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1402 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1403 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1404 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1405 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1406
1407 Example:
1408
1409 global
1410 grace 10s
1411
1412 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1413 frontend ext-check
1414 bind :9999
1415 monitor-uri /ext-check
1416 monitor fail if { stopping }
1417
1418 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1419 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1420 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1421 SIGUSR1 signal.
1422
1423 Example:
1424
1425 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1426 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1427 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1428 frontend ext-check
1429 bind :9999
1430 monitor-uri /ext-check
1431 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1432
1433 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1434
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001435group <group name>
1436 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1437 See also "gid" and "user".
1438
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001439hard-stop-after <time>
1440 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1441
1442 Arguments :
1443 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1444 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1445 SIGUSR1 signal.
1446
1447 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1448 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1449 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1450
1451 Example:
1452 global
1453 hard-stop-after 30s
1454
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001455 See also: grace
1456
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001457h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1458 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1459
1460 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1461 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1462 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1463 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1464 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1465 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1466 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1467
1468 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1469 option may be set.
1470
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001471h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1472 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1473 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1474 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1475 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001476 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001477 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1478 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1479 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1480 specified in a proxy.
1481
1482 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1483 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1484 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1485 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1486 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1487 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1488 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1489
1490 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1491 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1492 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1493 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1494 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1495
1496 Example:
1497 global
1498 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1499
1500 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1501 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1502
1503h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1504 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1505 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1506 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1507 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1508 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1509 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1510 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1511 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1512
1513 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1514 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1515 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1516
1517 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1518 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1519
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001520httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1521 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1522 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1523 server line.
1524
1525 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1526 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1527 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1528
1529 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1530 configuration error if it fails.
1531
1532httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1533 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1534 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1535
1536 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1537 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1538
1539 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1540 configuration error if it fails.
1541
1542httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1543 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1544 to resolve.
1545
1546 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1547 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1548
1549 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1550 configuration error if it fails to load.
1551
1552httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1553 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1554 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1555 option is "ipv6".
1556
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001557insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001558 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001559 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1560 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1561 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1562 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1563 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1564 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1565 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001566 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001567 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1568 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1569 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1570 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1571 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1572 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1573 disable it.
1574
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001575insecure-setuid-wanted
1576 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1577 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1578 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1579 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001580 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001581 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001582 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001583 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1584 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001585 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001586 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1587 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1588 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1589 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1590
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001591issuers-chain-path <dir>
1592 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1593 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1594 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001595 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001596 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1597 "issuers-chain-path".
1598 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1599 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1600 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1601 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1602 will share the chain in memory.
1603
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001604h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1605 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1606 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1607 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1608 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1609 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1610 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1611 the keyword with "no'.
1612
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001613localpeer <name>
1614 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1615 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1616 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1617 the configuration parsing.
1618
1619 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1620 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1621
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001622log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001623 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001624 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001626 configured with "log global".
1627
1628 <address> can be one of:
1629
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001630 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001631 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1632 port).
1633
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001634 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1635 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1636 port).
1637
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001638 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001639 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1640 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001641 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001642
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001643 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1644 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1645 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1646 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1647 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1648 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1649 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1650 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1651 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1652 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001653 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001654 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1655 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1656 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001657 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1658 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001659
1660 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1661 "fd@2", see above.
1662
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001663 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1664 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1665 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1666 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1667 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1668
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001669 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1670 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001671
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001672 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1673 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1674 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1675 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1676 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1677 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1678 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1679 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1680 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1681 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001682 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1683 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001684
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001685 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1686 one of the following :
1687
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001688 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1689 field is stripped. This is the default.
1690 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1691 rfc3164.
1692
1693 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001694 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1695
1696 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1697 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1698
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001699 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1700 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1701 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1702 designed to be used with a local log server.
1703
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001704 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1705 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1706 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1707 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1708 logger consumes.
1709
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001710 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1711 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1712 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1713 used with a local log server.
1714
1715 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1716 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1717 designed to be used with a local log server.
1718
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001719 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1720 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1721 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1722 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1723
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001724 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1725 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1726 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1727 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1728 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1729
1730 <sample_size>
1731 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1732 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1733 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1734 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1735 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1736
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001737 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001738
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001739 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1740 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1741 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1742
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001743 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1744 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1745 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1746 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001747
1748 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001749 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1750 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1751 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1752 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1753 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1754 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001755
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001756 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001757
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001758log-send-hostname [<string>]
1759 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1760 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1761 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1762 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1763 the logs.
1764
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001765log-tag <string>
1766 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1767 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1768 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001769 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001770
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001771lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001772 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1773 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1774 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1775 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1776 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1777 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001778 used multiple times.
1779
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001780lua-load-per-thread <file>
1781 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1782 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1783 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1784 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1785 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1786 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1787 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1788 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1789 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1790 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1791 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1792 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1793 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1794 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1795 times.
1796
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001797lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1798 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1799 variable.
1800 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1801 to "path".
1802
1803 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1804 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1805 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1806 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1807 will be checked earlier.
1808
1809 As an example by specifying the following path:
1810
1811 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1812 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1813
1814 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1815 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1816 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1817 paths if that does not exist either.
1818
1819 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1820 documentation.
1821
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001822master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001823 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1824 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1825 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001826 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001827 or daemon mode.
1828
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001829 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1830 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1831 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1832 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1833 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001834
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001835 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001836
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001837mworker-max-reloads <number>
1838 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001839 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001840 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1841 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1842 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1843
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001844nbthread <number>
1845 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001846 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1847 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1848 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1849 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1850 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1851 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1852 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001853
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001854numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001855 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1856 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1857 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1858 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1859 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1860 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1861 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1862 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1863 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1864 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001865
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001866pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001867 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1868 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1869 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1870 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001871
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001872pp2-never-send-local
1873 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1874 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1875 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1876 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1877 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1878 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1879 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1880 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1881 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1882 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1883 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1884
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001885presetenv <name> <value>
1886 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1887 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1888 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1889 and "unsetenv".
1890
1891resetenv [<name> ...]
1892 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1893 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1894 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1895 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1896 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1897 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1898 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1899 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1900
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001901stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001902 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1903 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1904 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001905
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001906server-state-base <directory>
1907 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001908 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1909 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001910
1911server-state-file <file>
1912 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1913 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1914 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1915 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1916 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1917 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1918 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1919 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001920 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1921 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001922
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001923set-var <var-name> <expr>
1924 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1925 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1926 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1927 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1928 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1929 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001930 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001931 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1932 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1933
1934 Example:
1935 global
1936 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1937 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1938 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1939
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001940set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1941 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1942 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1943 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1944 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1945 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1946 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1947 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1948 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1949 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1950 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1951
1952 Example:
1953 global
1954 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1955 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1956
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001957setenv <name> <value>
1958 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1959 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1960 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1961 and "unsetenv".
1962
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001963set-dumpable
1964 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001965 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1966 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1967 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1968 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1969 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1970 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1971 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1972 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1973 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1974 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1975 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1976 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1977 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1978 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1979 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001980 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001981 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001982
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001983ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1985 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001986 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001987 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001988 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1989 information and recommendations see e.g.
1990 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1991 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1992 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1993 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001994
1995ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1997 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1998 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1999 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2000 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002001 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2002 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2003 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002004 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002005
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002006ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2007 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2008 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2009 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2010 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2011 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2012
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002013ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2015 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2016 keyword to see available options.
2017
2018 Example:
2019 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002020 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002021
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002022ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2024 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002025 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002026 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002027 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2028 information and recommendations see e.g.
2029 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2030 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2031 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2032 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2033 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002034
2035ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2037 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2038 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2039 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2040 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002041 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2042 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2043 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2044 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002045
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002046ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2048 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2049 keyword to see available options.
2050
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002051ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2053 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2054 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002055 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002056 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002057 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002058 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2059 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2060 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2061 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002062 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2063 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2064 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2065
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002066ssl-propquery <query>
2067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2068 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2069 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2070 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2071 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2072 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2073 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2074 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2075 was not found.
2076
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002077ssl-provider <name>
2078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2079 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2080 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2081 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2082 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2083 appearance.
2084 Please note that loading a provider explicitely prevents OpenSSL from loading
2085 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2086 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2087 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2088 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2089 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
2090 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2091 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2092 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2093 where your provider can be found.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002094 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2095
2096ssl-provider-path <path>
2097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2098 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2099 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2100 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2101 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2102 defined.
2103 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002104
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002105ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2106 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2107 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002108 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002109 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002110 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2111
2112 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002113
2114 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2115 and won't try to remove them.
2116
2117 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2118
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002119ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002120 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002121 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2122 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2123 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002124
2125 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2126 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2127 optimize the startup time.
2128
2129 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2130 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2131 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2132
2133 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002134 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002135
2136 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002137 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2138 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002139
2140 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2141 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2142 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2143 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2144 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002145 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002146
2147 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002148 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002149 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2150 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2151 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2152 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2153 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002154 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002155
2156 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2157
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002158 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002159 a cert bundle.
2160
2161 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2162 separately in several "crt".
2163
2164 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2165 since files are loading separately.
2166
2167 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2168 required to commit them.
2169
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002170 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002171 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002172
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002173 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2174 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2175 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002176
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002177 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2178 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2179 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002180
2181 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002182 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2183 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002184
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002185 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2186 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2187
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002188 The default behavior is "all".
2189
2190 Example:
2191 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2192 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2193 ssl-load-extra-files none
2194
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002195 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2196 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002197
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002198ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2199 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2200 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2201 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2202
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002203ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002204 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002205 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2206 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2207 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2208 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2209 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2210 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002211 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002212
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002213stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2214 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2215 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2216 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002217 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002218 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002219
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002220 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2221 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2222 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002223
2224stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2225 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2226 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002227 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002228
2229stats maxconn <connections>
2230 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2231 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2232
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002233thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2234 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2235 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2236 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2237 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2238 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2239 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2240 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2241 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2242 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2243
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002244thread-groups <number>
2245 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2246 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2247 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2248
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002249uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002250 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002251 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2252 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2253 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2254
2255ulimit-n <number>
2256 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2257 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002258 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2259 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002260
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002261 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2262 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2263 manually specify this value.
2264
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002265 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2266
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002267unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2268 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2269
2270 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2271 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2272 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2273 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2274 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002275 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002276 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2277 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2278 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2279 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2280
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002281unsetenv [<name> ...]
2282 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2283 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2284 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2285 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2286 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2287 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2288 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2289
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002290user <user name>
2291 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2292 See also "uid" and "group".
2293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002294node <name>
2295 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2296
2297 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2298 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2299 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2300 traffic.
2301
2302description <text>
2303 Add a text that describes the instance.
2304
2305 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2306 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2307 "<" and ">" characters.
2308
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100230951degrees-data-file <file path>
2310 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002311 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002312
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002313 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002314 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2315
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000231651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002317 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2318 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2319 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2320
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002321 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002322 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2323
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200232451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002325 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2326 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2327
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002328 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002329 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2330
233151degrees-cache-size <number>
2332 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2333 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2334 By default, this cache is disabled.
2335
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002336 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002337 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2338
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002339wurfl-data-file <file path>
2340 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2341 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2342
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002343 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002344 with USE_WURFL=1.
2345
2346wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2347 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2348 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2349 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2350
2351 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2352
2353 Valid WURFL properties are:
2354 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2355
2356 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2357 device.
2358
2359 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2360 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2361
2362 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2363 particular web request.
2364
2365 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2366 used Libwurfl API version.
2367
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002368 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2369 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2370
2371 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2372 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2373
2374 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2375
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002376 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002377 with USE_WURFL=1.
2378
2379wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2380 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2381 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2382
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002383 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002384 with USE_WURFL=1.
2385
2386wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2387 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2388 thus before the chroot.
2389
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002390 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002391 with USE_WURFL=1.
2392
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002393wurfl-cache-size <size>
2394 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2395 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002396 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002397 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002398
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002399 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002400 with USE_WURFL=1.
2401
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002402strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002403 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002404 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2405 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002406 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002407 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024093.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002410-----------------------
2411
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002412busy-polling
2413 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2414 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2415 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2416 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2417 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2418 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2419 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2420 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2421 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2422 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2423 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2424 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2425 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2426 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2427 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2428 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2429 "poll" pollers.
2430
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002431 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2432 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2433 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2434
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002435max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002436 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002437 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2438 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2439 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2440 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2441 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2442 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2443 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2444
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002445maxconn <number>
2446 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2447 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2448 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002449 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2450 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2451 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2452 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002453 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2454 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2455 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2456 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2457 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002458 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2459
2460 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002461
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002462maxconnrate <number>
2463 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2464 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2465 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2466 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2467 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2468 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2469 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2470 fairness.
2471
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002472maxcomprate <number>
2473 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002474 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002475 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2476 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2477 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002478 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002479 default value.
2480
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002481maxcompcpuusage <number>
2482 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2483 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2484 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002485 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2486 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2487 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2488 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002489
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002490maxpipes <number>
2491 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2492 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2493 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2494 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2495 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2496 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2497
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002498maxsessrate <number>
2499 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2500 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2501 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2502 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2503 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2504 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2505 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2506 fairness.
2507
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002508maxsslconn <number>
2509 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2510 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2511 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2512 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2513 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2514 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2515 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002516 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2517 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2518 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2519 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002521 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2522 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002523
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002524maxsslrate <number>
2525 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2526 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2527 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2528 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2529 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2530 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2531 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2532 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2533 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2534 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2535
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002536maxzlibmem <number>
2537 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2538 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2539 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002540 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2541 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2542 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2543
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002544no-memory-trimming
2545 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2546 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2547 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2548 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2549 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2550 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2551 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2552 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2553 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2554 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2555 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2556 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2557 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2558 not suffer from such a problem.
2559
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002560noepoll
2561 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2562 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002563 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002564
2565nokqueue
2566 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2567 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2568 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2569
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002570noevports
2571 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2572 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2573 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2574 also "nopoll".
2575
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002576nopoll
2577 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2578 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002580 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2581 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002582
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002583nosplice
2584 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002585 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002586 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002587 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002588 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2589 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2590 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2591 "option splice-response".
2592
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002593nogetaddrinfo
2594 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2595 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2596
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002597noreuseport
2598 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2599 command line argument "-dR".
2600
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002601profiling.memory { on | off }
2602 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2603 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2604 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2605 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2606 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2607 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2608 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2609 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2610 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2611
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002612profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2613 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2614 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2615 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2616 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002617 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002618 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2619 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2620 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2621 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2622
2623 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2624 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2625 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2626 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2627 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002628 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2629 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2630 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2631 CLI.
2632
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002633spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002634 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2635 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2636 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2637 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2638 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2639 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002640
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002641ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002642 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002643 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002644 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002645 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002646 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2647 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2648 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002649 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2650 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002651 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2652 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2653 openssl configuration file uses:
2654 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2655
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002656ssl-mode-async
2657 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002658 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002659 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2660 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002661 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002662 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002663 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002664
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002665tune.buffers.limit <number>
2666 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2667 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2668 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2669 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2670 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002671 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002672 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2673 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2674 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2675 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2676 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2677 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2678 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2679 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002680 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002681
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002682tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2683 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2684 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2685 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002686 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002687
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002688tune.bufsize <number>
2689 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2690 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2691 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2692 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2693 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2694 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2695 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002696 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2697 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002698 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002699 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002700 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002701 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2702 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002703
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002704tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2705 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2706 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2707 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2708 this value. The default value is 1.
2709
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002710tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002711 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2712 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2713 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2714 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002715
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002716tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2717 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2718 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2719 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2720 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2721 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2722
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002723tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2724 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2725 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2726 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2727 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2728 change it.
2729
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002730tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2731 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002732 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002733 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002734 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2735 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2736 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2737 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2738 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2739
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002740tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2741 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2742 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2743 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2744 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2745 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002746 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002747 recommended not to change this value.
2748
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002749tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002750 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002751 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002752 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002753 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2754 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2755 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2756 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2757
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002758tune.http.cookielen <number>
2759 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2760 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2761 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2762 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2763 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2764 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2765 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2766 to change this value.
2767
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002768tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002769 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2770 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002771 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002772 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002773 configuration directives too.
2774 The default value is 1024.
2775
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002776tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2777 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2778 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2779 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2780 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2781 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2782 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002783 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2784 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2785 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002786
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002787tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2788 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2789 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2790 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2791 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2792 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2793 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002794 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2795 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2796 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2797 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2798 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002799
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002800tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002801 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002802 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2803 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2804 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2805 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002806 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002807 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002808 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002809 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2810
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002811tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2812 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2813 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2814 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2815 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2816 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2817 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2818 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2819 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2820 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2821
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002822tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2823 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002824 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002825 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2826 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002827 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002828 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2829 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2830
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002831tune.lua.maxmem
2832 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2833 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2834 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2835 memory.
2836
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002837tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2838 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002839 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2840 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002841 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002842
2843tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2844 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2845 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2846 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2847 check servers.
2848
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002849tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2850 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2851 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2852 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002853 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002854
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002855tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002856 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2857 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002858 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2859 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2860 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2861 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2862 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2863 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2864 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2865 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2866 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002867
2868tune.maxpollevents <number>
2869 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2870 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2871 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2872 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2873 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2874
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002875tune.maxrewrite <number>
2876 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2877 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2878 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2879 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2880 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2881 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2882 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2883 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2884 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2885 bufsize.
2886
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002887tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2888 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2889 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2890 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2891 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2892 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2893 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2894 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2895 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2896 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002897 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2898 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002899 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2900 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2901 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2902 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2903 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2904 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2905 setting this parameter to 0.
2906
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002907tune.pipesize <number>
2908 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2909 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2910 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2911 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2912 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2913 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2914
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002915tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2916 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002917 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002918 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2919 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2920 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2921 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002922 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002923
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002924tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2925 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002926 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002927 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2928 default is 20.
2929
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02002930tune.quic.conn-buf-limit <number>
2931 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2932 change without deprecation in the future.
2933
2934 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
2935 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
2936 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
2937 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
2938 time-trip.
2939
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002940tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2941tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2942 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2943 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2944 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002945 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002946 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002947 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2948 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2949
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002950tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002951 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002952 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2953 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2954 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2955 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2956
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002957tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002958 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002959 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2960 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2961 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2962 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2963 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2964 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2965 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002966
2967tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2968 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002969 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002970 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2971 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2972 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2973 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2974 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2975 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2976 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002977
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002978tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2979tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2980 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2981 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2982 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002983 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002984 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002985 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2986 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2987 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2988 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002989 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002990
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002991tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002992 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002993 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2994 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2995 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2996 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2997 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2998 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2999 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3000 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3001 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003002 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3003 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003004
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003005tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003006 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003007 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3008 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3009 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3010 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3011 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3012
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003013tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3014 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3015 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3016 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3017 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3018
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003019tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3020 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3021 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3022 performances. This is disabled by default.
3023
3024 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3025 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3026
3027 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3028
3029 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3030
3031 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3032
3033 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3034 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3035 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3036
3037 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3038 converted.
3039
3040 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3041 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3042 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3043 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3044 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3045 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3046 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003047 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3048 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003049
3050 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3051
3052 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3053 only need this line:
3054
3055 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3056
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003057tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3058 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003059 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003060 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3061 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3062 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3063 being used for too long.
3064
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003065tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003066 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3067 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3068 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3069 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3070 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3071 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3072 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3073 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3074 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3075 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3076 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3077 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3078 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003079
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003080tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3081 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3082 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3083 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3084 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02003085 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3086 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3087 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3088 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3089 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3090 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3091 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3092 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003093
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003094tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3095 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3096 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3097 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3098 1000 entries.
3099
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02003100tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3101tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02003102 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3103 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3104 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3105 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01003106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003107tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003108tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003109tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3110tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3111tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003112 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3113 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3114 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3115 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3116 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3117 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3118 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3119 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003120
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003121 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3122 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3123 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3124 all available space is consumed.
3125 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3126 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3127 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003128
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003129tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3130 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003131 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003132 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003133 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003134 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3135
3136tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3137 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3138 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003139 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3140 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031423.3. Debugging
3143--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003144
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003145quiet
3146 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3147 line argument "-q".
3148
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003149zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003150 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003151 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3152 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3153 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3154 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3155 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3156
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010031583.4. Userlists
3159--------------
3160It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3161http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3162it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3163
3164userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003165 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003166 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3167
3168group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003169 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003170 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3171 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3172
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003173user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3174 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003175 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3176 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003177 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3178 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3179 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3180 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003181
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003182 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3183 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3184 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3185 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3186 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3187 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3188 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003189 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003190 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003191
3192 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003193 userlist L1
3194 group G1 users tiger,scott
3195 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003196
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003197 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3198 user scott insecure-password elgato
3199 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003200
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003201 userlist L2
3202 group G1
3203 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3206 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3207 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003208
3209 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003210
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003211
32123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003213----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003214It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003215several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003216instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003217values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3218type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3219values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3220active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3221switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3222present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3223watch it.
3224
3225Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3226known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3227the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3228process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3229during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3230tables.
3231
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003232Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3233that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3234each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003235
3236peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003237 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003238 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3239
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003240bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3241 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3242 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3243
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003244disabled
3245 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3246 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3247 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3248
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003249default-bind [param*]
3250 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3251
3252default-server [param*]
3253 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3254
3255 Arguments:
3256 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3257 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3258 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3259 details.
3260
3261
3262 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3263
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003264enabled
3265 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3266 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003267
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003268log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003269 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3270 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3271 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3272 more details.
3273
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003274peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003275 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3276 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003277 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003278 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003279 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3280 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3281 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003282
3283 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3284 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3285
3286 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003287 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3288 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3289 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003290
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003291 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3292 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003293
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003294 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3295 "server" keyword explanation below).
3296
3297server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003298 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003299 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3300 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +02003301 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003302 of this "peers" section).
3303 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3304
3305
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003306 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003307 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003308 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003309 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3310 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3311 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003312
3313 backend mybackend
3314 mode tcp
3315 balance roundrobin
3316 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3317 stick on src
3318
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003319 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3320 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003321
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003322 Example:
3323 peers mypeers
3324 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3325 default-server ssl verify none
3326 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3327 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003328
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003329
3330table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3331 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3332
3333 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3334 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003335 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003336 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3337 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3338 "stick-table" keyword).
3339
3340 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3341 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3342 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3343 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3344 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3345 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3346 of the stick-table name as follows:
3347
3348 peers mypeers
3349 peer A ...
3350 peer B ...
3351 table t1 ...
3352
3353 frontend fe1
3354 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3355
3356 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3357 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3358
3359 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3360 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3361 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3362 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3363 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3364 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3365 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3366
3367 peers mypeers
3368 peer A ...
3369 peer B ...
3370 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3371
3372 backend t1
3373 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3374
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003375 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003376 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3377 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3378
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090033793.6. Mailers
3380------------
3381It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3382If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3383in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3384
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003385mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003386 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3387 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3388
3389mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3390 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3391
3392 Example:
3393 mailers mymailers
3394 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3395 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3396
3397 backend mybackend
3398 mode tcp
3399 balance roundrobin
3400
3401 email-alert mailers mymailers
3402 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3403 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3404
3405 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3406 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3407
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003408timeout mail <time>
3409 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3410 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3411 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3412 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3413
3414 Example:
3415 mailers mymailers
3416 timeout mail 20s
3417 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003418
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020034193.7. Programs
3420-------------
3421In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3422master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3423managed the same way as the workers.
3424
3425During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3426sequence as a worker:
3427
3428 - the master is re-executed
3429 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3430 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3431 instance of the program
3432
3433During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3434
3435program <name>
3436 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3437 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3438 the management guide).
3439
3440command <command> [arguments*]
3441 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3442 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3443 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3444 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3445
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003446user <user name>
3447 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3448 See also "group".
3449
3450group <group name>
3451 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3452 See also "user".
3453
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003454option start-on-reload
3455no option start-on-reload
3456 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3457 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3458 program section.
3459
3460
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010034613.8. HTTP-errors
3462----------------
3463
3464It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3465imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3466several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3467
3468http-errors <name>
3469 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3470 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3471
3472errorfile <code> <file>
3473 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3474
3475 Arguments :
3476 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003477 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003478 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003479
3480 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3481 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3482 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3483 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3484 before any chroot is performed.
3485
3486 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3487
3488 Example:
3489 http-errors website-1
3490 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3491 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3492 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3493
3494 http-errors website-2
3495 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3496 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3497 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3498
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020034993.9. Rings
3500----------
3501
3502It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3503servers or traces.
3504
3505ring <ringname>
3506 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3507
3508description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003509 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003510 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3511
3512format <format>
3513 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3514
3515 Arguments:
3516 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3517 one of the following :
3518
3519 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3520 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3521 designed to be used with a local log server.
3522
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003523 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3524 field is stripped. This is the default.
3525 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3526 rfc3164.
3527
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003528 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3529 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3530 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3531 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3532 is the default.
3533
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003534 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003535 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3536
3537 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3538 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3539
3540 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3541 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3542 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3543 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3544 logger consumes.
3545
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003546 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3547 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3548 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3549 with a local log server.
3550
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003551 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3552 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3553 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3554 used with a local log server.
3555
3556maxlen <length>
3557 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3558 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3559 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3560
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003561server <name> <address> [param*]
3562 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3563 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3564 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3565 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3566 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3567 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3568 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3569 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3570 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003571 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3572 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003573
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003574size <size>
3575 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3576 set to BUFSIZE.
3577
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003578timeout connect <timeout>
3579 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3580
3581 Arguments :
3582 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3583 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3584 as explained at the top of this document.
3585
3586timeout server <timeout>
3587 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3588
3589 Arguments :
3590 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3591 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3592 as explained at the top of this document.
3593
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003594 Example:
3595 global
3596 log ring@myring local7
3597
3598 ring myring
3599 description "My local buffer"
3600 format rfc3164
3601 maxlen 1200
3602 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003603 timeout connect 5s
3604 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003605 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003606
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020036073.10. Log forwarding
3608-------------------
3609
3610It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003611HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003612
3613log-forward <name>
3614 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3615
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003616backlog <conns>
3617 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3618 on connections accept.
3619
3620bind <addr> [param*]
3621 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003622 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3623 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3624 syslog protocol over TCP.
3625 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003626 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3627
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003628dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003629 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3630 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3631 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3632 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003633 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003634
3635log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003636log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003637 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3638 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3639 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003640 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003641 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3642 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3643 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003644 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003645
3646 Example:
3647 global
3648 log stderr format iso local7
3649
3650 ring myring
3651 description "My local buffer"
3652 format rfc5424
3653 maxlen 1200
3654 size 32764
3655 timeout connect 5s
3656 timeout server 10s
3657 # syslog tcp server
3658 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3659
3660 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003661 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3662 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003663 # all messages on stderr
3664 log global
3665 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3666 log ring@myring local0
3667 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3668 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3669 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3670 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3671 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003672
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003673maxconn <conns>
3674 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3675 10 is the default.
3676
3677timeout client <timeout>
3678 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036804. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003681----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003683Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003684 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3685 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3686 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3687 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003688
3689A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3690connections.
3691
3692A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3693to forward incoming connections.
3694
3695A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3696parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3697
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003698A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3699ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3700sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3701the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3702explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3703from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3704"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3705for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3706to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3707optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3708are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3709any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3710names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3711that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3712duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003713names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3714is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3715implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3716encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3717adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003718
3719Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3720settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3721of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3722profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3723timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3726'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3727case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3728
3729Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3730logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3731proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3732However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3733name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3734
3735Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3736and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003737bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003738protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3739modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3740arbitrary criteria.
3741
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003742In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3743a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003744the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003745
3746 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3747 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3748 between responses and new requests.
3749
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003750 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3751 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3752 client-facing connection remains open.
3753
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003754 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3755 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003756
3757The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3758frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3759following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003760weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003761
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003762 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003763
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003764 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3765 ----+-----+-----+----
3766 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3767 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003768 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3769 ----+-----+-----+----
3770 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003771
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003772It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003773only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3774within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003775as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003776content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003777and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3778possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003780There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003781first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003782processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003783second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003784protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3785is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3786new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003787to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003788process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3789already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3790HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3791evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3792one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3793
3794There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3795performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3796tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3797preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3798analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3799HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3800header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3801mitigate this drawback.
3802
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003803There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003804method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3805set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3806in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3807is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3808to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3809above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3810to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3811"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3812frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3813frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3814as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3815upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3816on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3817the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3818upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3819frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3820remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038224.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3823--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003825The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3826limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3827they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3828limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003829marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003830option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003831and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3832with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003833specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3834sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3835anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003836
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003837
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003838 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3839------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003840acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003841backlog X X X -
3842balance X - X X
3843bind - X X -
3844bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003845capture cookie - X X -
3846capture request header - X X -
3847capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003848clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3849clitcpka-idle X X X -
3850clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003851compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003852cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003853declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003854default-server X - X X
3855default_backend X X X -
3856description - X X X
3857disabled X X X X
3858dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003859email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003860email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861email-alert mailers X X X X
3862email-alert myhostname X X X X
3863email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003864enabled X X X X
3865errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003866errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003867errorloc X X X X
3868errorloc302 X X X X
3869-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3870errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003871error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003872force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003873filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003874fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003875hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003876http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003877http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003878http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003879http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003880http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003881http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003882http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003883http-check set-var X - X X
3884http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003885http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003886http-request X (!) X X X
3887http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003888http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003889http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003890id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003891ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003892load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003893log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003894log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003895log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003896log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003897max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003898maxconn X X X -
3899mode X X X X
3900monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003901monitor-uri X X X -
3902option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3903option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3904option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3905option allbackups (*) X - X X
3906option checkcache (*) X - X X
3907option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3908option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003909option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003910option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3911option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003912-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3913option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003914option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3915option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003916option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003917option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003918option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003919option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003920option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003921option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003922option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3923option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3924option httpchk X - X X
3925option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003926option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003927option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003928option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003929option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003930option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003931option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3932option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3933option logasap (*) X X X -
3934option mysql-check X - X X
3935option nolinger (*) X X X X
3936option originalto X X X X
3937option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003938option pgsql-check X - X X
3939option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003940option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003941option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003942option smtpchk X - X X
3943option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3944option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3945option splice-request (*) X X X X
3946option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003947option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003948option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3949option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3950-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003951option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003952option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3953option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3954option tcpka X X X X
3955option tcplog X X X X
3956option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003957option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003958external-check command X - X X
3959external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003960persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3961rate-limit sessions X X X -
3962redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003963-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003964retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003965retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003966server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003967server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003968server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003969source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003970srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3971srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3972srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003973stats admin - X X X
3974stats auth X X X X
3975stats enable X X X X
3976stats hide-version X X X X
3977stats http-request - X X X
3978stats realm X X X X
3979stats refresh X X X X
3980stats scope X X X X
3981stats show-desc X X X X
3982stats show-legends X X X X
3983stats show-node X X X X
3984stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3986stick match - - X X
3987stick on - - X X
3988stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003989stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003990stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003991tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003992tcp-check connect X - X X
3993tcp-check expect X - X X
3994tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003995tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003996tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003997tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003998tcp-check set-var X - X X
3999tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004000tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4001tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4002tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4003tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4004tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4005tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004006timeout check X - X X
4007timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004008timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004009timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004010timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4011timeout http-request X X X X
4012timeout queue X - X X
4013timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004014timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004015timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004016timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004017transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004018unique-id-format X X X -
4019unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004020use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004021use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004022use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004023------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4024 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020040274.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4028---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029
4030This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4031
4032
4033acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4034 Declare or complete an access list.
4035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004036 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4037
4038 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4039 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4040 using it.
4041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004042 Example:
4043 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4044 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4045 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004047 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004048
4049
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004050backlog <conns>
4051 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4053 yes | yes | yes | no
4054 Arguments :
4055 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4056 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004057 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004058
4059 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4060 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4061 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4062 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4063 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4064 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4065 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4066 backlog parameter.
4067
4068 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4069 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4070 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4071
4072 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4073
4074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004076balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004077 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | no | yes | yes
4080 Arguments :
4081 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4082 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4083 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4084 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4085
4086 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4087 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4088 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4089 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004090 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004091 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004092 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4093 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4094 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4095 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4096 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4097 it, so that you don't worry.
4098
4099 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4100 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4101 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4102 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4103 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4104 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4105 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4106 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004107
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004108 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4109 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4110 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4111 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4112 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4113 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4114 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004115 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4116 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4117 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004118
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004119 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004120 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004121 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4122 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004123 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004124 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4125 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4126 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4127 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4128 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004129 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4130 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4131 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4132 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4133 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4134 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004135
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004136 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4137 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4138 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4139 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4140 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4141 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4142 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4143 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4144 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4145 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4146 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4147 changed using "hash-type".
4148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004149 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4150 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4151 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4152 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4153 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4154 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4155 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4156 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004157 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004159 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4160 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004161 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004163 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4164 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4165 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4166 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4167 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4168 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4169 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4170 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4171 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4172 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4173 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4174 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004176 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004177 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4178 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4179 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4180 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4181 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4182 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4183 URIs start with a leading "/".
4184
4185 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4186 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4187 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4188 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4189
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004190 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4191 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4192 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004193 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4194 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004196 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004197 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4198
4199 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004200 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4201 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004202 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4203 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4204 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4205 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004206 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004207 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4208 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004209
4210 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4211 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4212 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4213 server will receive the request.
4214
4215 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4216 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4217 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4218 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4219 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004220 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4221 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004222 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4223 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004225 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4226 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4227 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4228 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4229 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004231 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004232 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4233 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4234 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4235
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004236 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4237 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004238 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4239 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004240
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004241 random
4242 random(<draws>)
4243 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004244 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4245 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4246 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4247 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004248 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4249 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4250 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4251 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4252 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4253 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4254 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4255 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4256 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4257 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4258 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4259 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4260 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4261 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4262 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4263 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4264 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4265 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4266 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4267 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004268
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004269 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004270 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004271 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4272 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004273 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004274 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4275 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4276 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004277 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004278 used instead.
4279
4280 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4281 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4282 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004283 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004284
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004285 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4286 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004287 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4288 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004289
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004290 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004291 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4292 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004293
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004294 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4295 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4296 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004297
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004298 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004299 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004300 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4301 NTLM relies on.
4302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303 Examples :
4304 balance roundrobin
4305 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004306 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004307 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4308 balance hdr(host)
4309 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004310 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4311 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4312 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004313
4314 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4315 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004317 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004318 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4319 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4320 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004321 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004322
4323 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4324 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4325 defaults to 16 kB.
4326
4327 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4328 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4329
4330 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4331 Round Robin.
4332
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004333 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004334 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4335 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4336 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4337
4338 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4339
4340 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004341 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004342 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4343 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4344 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004346 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004347
4348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004349bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4350bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004351 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4353 no | yes | yes | no
4354 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004355 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4356 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4357 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4358 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004359 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004360 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4361 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4362 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4363 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4364 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4365 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004366 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004367 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4368 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004369 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004370 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4371 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004372 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004373 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4374 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004375 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004376 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004377 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4378 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4379 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004380 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4381 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4382 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4383 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004384 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4385 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4386 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004387
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004388 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4389 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004390 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4391 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4392 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004393 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4394 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4395 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4396 the range.
4397
4398 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4399 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4400 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4401 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4402 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4403 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4404 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004405 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004406 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004407
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004408 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004409 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004410 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4411 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4412 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4413 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4414 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4415 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4416
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004417 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4418 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4419 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4420 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4423 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4424 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4425 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4426 in a frontend.
4427
4428 Example :
4429 listen http_proxy
4430 bind :80,:443
4431 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004432 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004433
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004434 listen http_https_proxy
4435 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004436 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004437
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004438 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4439 bind ipv6@:80
4440 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4441 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4442
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004443 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004445
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004446 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4447 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4448 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4449 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4450 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4451
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004452 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004453 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004454
4455
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004456bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4458 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004459
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004460 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4461 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4462 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4463 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4464 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4465 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004466
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004467 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004468
4469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004470capture cookie <name> len <length>
4471 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4473 no | yes | yes | no
4474 Arguments :
4475 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4476 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4477 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4478 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004479 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004480
4481 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4482 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4483 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4484 right if it exceeds <length>.
4485
4486 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4487 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4488 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4489 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4490
4491 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4492 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4493 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4494
4495 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4496 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4497 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004498 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4499 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4500 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501
4502 Example:
4503 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4504
4505 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004506 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507
4508
4509capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004510 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4512 no | yes | yes | no
4513 Arguments :
4514 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004515 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004516 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4517 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4518 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4519
4520 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4521 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4522 it exceeds <length>.
4523
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004524 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004525 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4526 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004527 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4528 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4529 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4530 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004531 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004532 environments to find where the request came from.
4533
4534 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4535 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4536 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4537 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004539 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4540 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4541 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4542 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4543 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544
4545 Example:
4546 capture request header Host len 15
4547 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004548 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004550 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004551 about logging.
4552
4553
4554capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004555 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4557 no | yes | yes | no
4558 Arguments :
4559 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004560 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4562 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4563 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4564
4565 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4566 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4567 it exceeds <length>.
4568
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004569 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4571 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4572 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004573 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4574 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4575 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4576 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004577
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004578 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4579 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4580 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4581 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4582 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004583
4584 Example:
4585 capture response header Content-length len 9
4586 capture response header Location len 15
4587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004588 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004589 about logging.
4590
4591
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004592clitcpka-cnt <count>
4593 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4594 the connection on the client side.
4595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 yes | yes | yes | no
4597 Arguments :
4598 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4599
4600 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4601 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004602 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4603 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004604
4605 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4606
4607
4608clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4609 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4610 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4611 client side.
4612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4613 yes | yes | yes | no
4614 Arguments :
4615 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4616 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4617 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4618 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4619
4620 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4621 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004622 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4623 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004624
4625 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4626
4627
4628clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4629 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4631 yes | yes | yes | no
4632 Arguments :
4633 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4634 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4635 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4636 document.
4637
4638 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4639 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004640 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4641 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004642
4643 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4644
4645
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004646compression algo <algorithm> ...
4647compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004648 Enable HTTP compression.
4649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 yes | yes | yes | yes
4651 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004652 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4653 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004654
4655 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004656 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4657 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4658 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004659
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004660 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004661 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004662
4663 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4664 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4665 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4666 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4667 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004668 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004669
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004670 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4671 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4672 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4673 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4674 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4675 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4676 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004677 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004678
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004679 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004680 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004681 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004682 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004683 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004684 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004685 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004686
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004687 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004688 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4689 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004690 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004691 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004692 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4693 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4694 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4695 "multipart"
4696 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4697 header
4698 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4699 and later
4700 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4701 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004702 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004703
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004704 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004705
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004706 Examples :
4707 compression algo gzip
4708 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004710 See also : "compression offload"
4711
4712compression offload
4713 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 no | yes | yes | yes
4716
4717 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4718 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4719 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4720 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4721 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4722 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4723 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4724 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4725 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4726 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4727 then be used for such scenarios.
4728
4729 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4730 option is ignored.
4731
4732 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004733
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004734cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004735 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4736 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004737 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 yes | no | yes | yes
4741 Arguments :
4742 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4743 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4744 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4745 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4746 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4747 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004748 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004749 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4750 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4751
4752 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004753 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004754 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4755 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4756 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4757 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004758 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4759 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004760 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004761 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4762 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004763
4764 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004765 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004766
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004767 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004768 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004769 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004770 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004771 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4772 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4773 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4774 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4775 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4776 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4777 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004778
4779 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4780 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4781 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4782 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4783 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4784 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4785 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4786 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4787 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004788 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004789 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4790 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4791 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004792
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004793 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4794 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4795 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004796 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4797 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4798 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4799 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004800 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4801 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4802 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004803
4804 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4805 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4806 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4807 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4808 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4809 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4810 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4811 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4812 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4813
4814 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4815 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4816 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4817 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4818 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4819 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4820 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4821 persistence cookie in the cache.
4822 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4823
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004824 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4825 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004826 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004827 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4828 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004829 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004830 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4831 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4832 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4833 they logout.
4834
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004835 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004836 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4837 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4838 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4839
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004840 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004841 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4842 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4843 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4844 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4845 this attribute.
4846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004847 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004848 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004849 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4850 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4851 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4852 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4853 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4854 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004855
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004856 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4857 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4858 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4859 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4860 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4861 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4862 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4863 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004864 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004865 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4866 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4867 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4868 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4869 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4870 the site.
4871
4872 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4873 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4874 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4875 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4876 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4877 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4878 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4879 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4880 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4881 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4882 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4883 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4884 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004885 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004886 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4887 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4888
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004889 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4890 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4891 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4892 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4893 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4894 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4895
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004896 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004897 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4898 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4899 repeated.
4900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004901 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4902 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4903 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4904 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004906 Examples :
4907 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4908 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4909 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004910 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004911
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004912 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004913
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004914
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004915declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4916 Declares a capture slot.
4917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4918 no | yes | yes | no
4919 Arguments:
4920 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4921
4922 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4923 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4924 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4925 for use in the response.
4926
4927 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004928 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004929 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4930
4931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004932default-server [param*]
4933 Change default options for a server in a backend
4934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4935 yes | no | yes | yes
4936 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004937 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4938 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4939 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4940 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004941
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004942 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004943 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4944
4945 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004946
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004948default_backend <backend>
4949 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | no
4952 Arguments :
4953 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4954
4955 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4956 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4957 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4958 will catch all undetermined requests.
4959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004960 Example :
4961
4962 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4963 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4964 default_backend dynamic
4965
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004966 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004968
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004969description <string>
4970 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 no | yes | yes | yes
4973 Arguments : string
4974
4975 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4976 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4977 it describes.
4978 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4979
4980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004981disabled
4982 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4984 yes | yes | yes | yes
4985 Arguments : none
4986
4987 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4988 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4989 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4990 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4991 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4992 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4993 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4994
4995 See also : "enabled"
4996
4997
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004998dispatch <address>:<port>
4999 Set a default server address
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005002 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005003
5004 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5005 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5006 during start-up.
5007
5008 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5009 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5010 possible with normal servers.
5011
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005012 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005013 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5014 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5015 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5016 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5017
5018 See also : "server"
5019
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005020
5021dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5022 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | no | yes | yes
5025 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5026
5027 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005028 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005029 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5030 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005031 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005032 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005034enabled
5035 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038 Arguments : none
5039
5040 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5041 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5042
5043 See also : "disabled"
5044
5045
5046errorfile <code> <file>
5047 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | yes | yes | yes
5050 Arguments :
5051 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005052 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005053 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005054
5055 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005056 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005057 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005058 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5059 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005060
5061 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5062 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5063 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5064
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005065 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5066
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005067 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5068 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5069 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5070 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5071 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5072 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5073 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5074 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5075 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005077 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5078 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5079 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005080 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005081 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5082
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005083 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005084
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005085 Example :
5086 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005087 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005088 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5089 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005091
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005092errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5093 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5094 section.
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | yes | yes | yes
5097 Arguments :
5098 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5099
5100 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005101 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005102 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5103 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005104
5105 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5106 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5107 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5108 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5109 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005110 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005111 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5112
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005113 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5114 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005115
5116 Example :
5117 errorfiles generic
5118 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5119
5120
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005121errorloc <code> <url>
5122errorloc302 <code> <url>
5123 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5125 yes | yes | yes | yes
5126 Arguments :
5127 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005128 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005129 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005130
5131 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5132 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5133 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5134 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005135 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005136
5137 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5138 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5139 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5140
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005141 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5142
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005143 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5144 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5145 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5146 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005147 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5149 request.
5150
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005151 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005152
5153
5154errorloc303 <code> <url>
5155 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | yes | yes | yes
5158 Arguments :
5159 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005160 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005161 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162
5163 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5164 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5165 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5166 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005167 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005168
5169 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5170 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5171 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5172
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005173 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5176 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5177 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5178 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005179 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005180
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005181 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005182
5183
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005184email-alert from <emailaddr>
5185 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005186 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5188 yes | yes | yes | yes
5189
5190 Arguments :
5191
5192 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5193
5194 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5195 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5196
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005197 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005198 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5199 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005200
5201
5202email-alert level <level>
5203 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5204 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 yes | yes | yes | yes
5207
5208 Arguments :
5209
5210 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5211 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5212 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5213
5214 By default level is alert
5215
5216 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5217 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5218 for the proxy.
5219
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005220 Alerts are sent when :
5221
5222 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5223 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5224 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5225 is notice or lower
5226 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5227 and a health check status update occurs
5228
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005229 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5230 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005231 section 3.6 about mailers.
5232
5233
5234email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5235 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5237 yes | yes | yes | yes
5238
5239 Arguments :
5240
5241 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5242
5243 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5244 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5245
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005246 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5247 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005248
5249
5250email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5251 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5252 mailers.
5253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5254 yes | yes | yes | yes
5255
5256 Arguments :
5257
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005258 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005259
5260 By default the systems hostname is used.
5261
5262 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5263 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5264 for the proxy.
5265
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005266 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5267 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005268
5269
5270email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005271 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005272 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | yes | yes | yes
5275
5276 Arguments :
5277
5278 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5279
5280 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5281 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5282
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005283 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005284 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5285
5286
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005287error-log-format <string>
5288 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5290 yes | yes | yes | no
5291
5292 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5293 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5294 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5295 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005296 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5297
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005298 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5299 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5300 string in depth.
5301
5302 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5303 directives.
5304
5305
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005306force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5307 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005309 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005310
5311 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5312 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5313 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5314 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5315 marked down for maintenance operations.
5316
5317 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5318 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5319 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5320 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5321 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5322 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5323 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5324 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5325 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5326
5327 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5328 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5329 is used.
5330
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005331 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005332 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005333
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005334
5335filter <name> [param*]
5336 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 no | yes | yes | yes
5339 Arguments :
5340 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5341 referenced in section 9.
5342
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005343 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005344 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005345 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5346 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005347
5348 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5349 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5350
5351 Example:
5352 listen
5353 bind *:80
5354
5355 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5356 filter compression
5357 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5358
5359 compression algo gzip
5360 compression offload
5361
5362 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5363
5364 See also : section 9.
5365
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005367fullconn <conns>
5368 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 yes | no | yes | yes
5371 Arguments :
5372 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5373 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5374
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005375 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005376 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005377 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005378 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5379 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5380 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5381 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5382 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005383 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005384
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005385 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005386 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005387 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5388 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5389 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005391 Example :
5392 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5393 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5394 # connections.
5395 backend dynamic
5396 fullconn 10000
5397 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5398 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5399
5400 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5401
5402
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005403hash-balance-factor <factor>
5404 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | no | no | yes
5407 Arguments :
5408 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5409 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005410 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005411
5412 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5413 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5414 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5415 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5416 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5417 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5418 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5419
5420 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5421 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5422 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5423 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5424 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5425
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005426 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5427 consistent hashing mechanism.
5428
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005429 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5430
5431
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005432hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005433 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5435 yes | no | yes | yes
5436 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005437 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5438 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005439
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005440 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5441 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5442 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5443 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5444 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5445 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5446 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5447 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5448 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5449 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005450
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005451 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5452 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5453 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5454 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5455 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5456 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5457 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5458 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5459 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5460 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5461 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5462 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5463 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005464 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5465 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005466
5467 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5468
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005469 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005470 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5471 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5472 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005473 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5474 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5475 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005476
5477 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5478 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005479 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5480 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5481 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5482 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005484 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005485 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5486 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5487 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5488 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5489 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5490 parameter.
5491
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005492 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5493 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5494 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5495 used on strings.
5496
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005497 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5498
5499 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5500 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5501 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5502 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5503 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5504 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5505 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5506 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5507 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5508 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5509 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5510 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005511
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005512 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5513 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5514 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005515
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005516 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005517
5518
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005519http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5520 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5521 ones).
5522
5523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005524 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005525
5526 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5527 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5528 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5529 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5530 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5531 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5532
5533 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5534 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5535 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5536
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005537 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5538 supported:
5539 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5540 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005541 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005542 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5543 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5544 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5545 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5546 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005547 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5548 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005549 - strict-mode { on | off }
5550 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5551
5552 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005553
5554 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5555 instance.
5556
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005557 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5558 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5559 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5560 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5561 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5562 a defaults section defining such rules.
5563
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005564 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5565 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5566 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5567
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005568 Example:
5569 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5570 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5571 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5572
5573http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5574
5575 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005576 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5577 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005578
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005579http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5580
5581 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5582 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5583 complete description.
5584
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005585http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5586
5587 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005588 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005589
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005590http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005591
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005592 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5593 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005594
5595http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5597
5598 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5599
5600 Example:
5601 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5602
5603 # applied to:
5604 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5605
5606 # outputs:
5607 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5608
5609 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5610
5611http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5612 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5613
5614 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5615
5616 Example:
5617 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5618
5619 # applied to:
5620 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5621
5622 # outputs:
5623 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5624
5625http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5626
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005627 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5628 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5629 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5630 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005631
5632http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5633 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5634
5635 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005636 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005637 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005638
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005639http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5640http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005641
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005642 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5643 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5644 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005645
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005646http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005647
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005648 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5649 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005650
5651http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5652
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005653 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5654 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005655
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005656
5657http-check comment <string>
5658 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5659 it fails.
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5661 yes | no | yes | yes
5662
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005663 Arguments :
5664 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5665 rule fails.
5666
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005667 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5668 user-friendly error reporting.
5669
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005670 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005671 "http-check expect".
5672
5673
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005674http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5675 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005676 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005677 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 yes | no | yes | yes
5680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005681 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005682 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5683
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005684 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005685 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005686
5687 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5688 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5689 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5690 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5691
5692 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5693
5694 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5695
5696 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5697
5698 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5699
5700 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5701
5702 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5703 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5704 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5705 is used.
5706
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005707 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5708 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5709 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5710 haproxy -vv.
5711
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005712 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5713
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005714 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5715 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5716 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5717 different ports or with different servers.
5718
5719 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5720 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5721 the port with a "http-check connect".
5722
5723 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5724 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5725 do.
5726
5727 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5728 unset-var or comment rules.
5729
5730 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005731 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5732 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5733 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5734 option httpchk
5735
5736 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005737 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005738 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005739 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005740 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005741 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005742
5743 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5744
5745 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005746
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005748http-check disable-on-404
5749 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005751 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005752 Arguments : none
5753
5754 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5755 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5756 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5757 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5758 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5759 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5760 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5761 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005762 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5763 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005764 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5765 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5766 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005767
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005768 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005769
5770
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005771http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005772 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5773 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5774 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005775 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005777 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005778
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005779 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005780 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5781
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005782 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5783 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5784 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5785 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5786 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5787 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5788 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5789 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5790 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5791 result is always conclusive.
5792
5793 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5794 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5795 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005796 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5797 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005798 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5799 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005800 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5801 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5802 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
5804 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5805 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005806 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5807 supported :
5808 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5809 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005810 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5811 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5812 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5813 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5814 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005815
5816 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5817 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005818 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5819 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5820 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5821 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005822 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5823
5824 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5825 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5826 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5827 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5828
5829 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5830 informational message reported in logs if an error
5831 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5832 log-format string.
5833
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005834 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005835 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5836 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005837 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5838 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5839 details on the supported keywords.
5840
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005841 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5842 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5843 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5844 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005845
5846 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5847 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5848 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5849 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5850 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5851
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005852 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5853 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5854 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5855 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5856 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5857 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5858 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005859
5860 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005861 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005862 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5863 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5864 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5865 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5866
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005867 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5868 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005869 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5870 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5871 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5872 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5873 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5874 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5875 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5876 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005877 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5878 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5879 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5880 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5881 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5882 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5883 insensitive on the header names.
5884
5885 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5886 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5887 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5888 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5889 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5890 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005891
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005892 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005893 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005894 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5895 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5896 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5897 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5898 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005899 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005900 trace).
5901
5902 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005903 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005904 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5905 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5906 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5907 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5908 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005909 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005910
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005911 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5912 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5913 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5914 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5915 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5916 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5917
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005918 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005919 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005920 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5921 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5922 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5923 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5924 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5925 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5926
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005927 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5928 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5929 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5930 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5931 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005932
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005933 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5934 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5935
5936 Examples :
5937 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005938 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005939
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005940 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5941 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5942
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005943 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005944 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005945
5946 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005947 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005948
5949 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005950 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005951
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005952 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005953 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005954
5955
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005956http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005957 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5958 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005959 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5960 health checks.
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | no | yes | yes
5963 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005964 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5965
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005966 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5967 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5968 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5969 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5970 to invent non-standard ones.
5971
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005972 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5973 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5974 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5975 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5976
5977 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5978 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5979 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5980 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005981
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005982 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005983 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005984 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005985 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5986 to add it.
5987
5988 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5989 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5990 to the log-format rules.
5991
5992 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5993 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5994 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005995
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005996 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5997 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5998 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5999 request.
6000
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006001 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6002 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6003 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006004 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6005 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6006 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6007 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006008 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006009
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006010 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006011 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6012 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006013
6014 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6015 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6016 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6017 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6018 configured request authority.
6019
6020 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6021 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006022
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006023 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006024
6025
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006026http-check send-state
6027 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6029 yes | no | yes | yes
6030 Arguments : none
6031
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006032 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006033 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006034 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6035 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6036 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006037
6038 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6039 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6040 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6041 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6042 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006043 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6044 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6045 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6046
6047 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6048 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6049 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6050
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006051 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6052 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6053 checked in multiple backends.
6054
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006055 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006056 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6057
6058 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6059 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6060 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6061 one fails.
6062
6063 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6064 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6065 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6066
6067 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6068 server's queue.
6069
6070 Example of a header received by the application server :
6071 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6072 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6073
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006074 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6075 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006076
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006077
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006078http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6079http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006080 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006084 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006085 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6086 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6087 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6088 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6089 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6090 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6091 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6092 and '-'.
6093
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006094 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6095 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006096 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006097 conditions.
6098
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006099 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6100
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006101 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6102 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6103
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006104 Examples :
6105 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006106 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006107
6108
6109http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006110 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6112 yes | no | yes | yes
6113
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006114 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006115 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6116 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6117 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6118 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6119 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6120 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6121 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6122 and '-'.
6123
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006124 Examples :
6125 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006127
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006128http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6129 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6130 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6131 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6132 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6134 yes | yes | yes | yes
6135 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006136 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006137 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006138 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006139 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006140
6141 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6142 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6143 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6144 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6145
6146 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6147 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6148 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6149 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6150
6151 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6152 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6153 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6154 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6155 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6156 chroot is performed.
6157
6158 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6159 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6160 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6161 considered.
6162
6163 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6164 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6165 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6166 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6167 considered as a raw string.
6168
6169 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6170 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6171 "content-type".
6172
6173 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6174 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6175 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6176 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6177 evaluated as a log-format string.
6178
6179 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6180 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6181 argument to "content-type".
6182
6183 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6184 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6185 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6186 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6187
6188 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6189 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6190 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6191 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6192 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6193 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6194 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6195 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6196
6197 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6198 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6199 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6200
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006201 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6202 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6203 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6204 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6205 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6206
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006207 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6208 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6209
6210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006211http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006212 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6213
6214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006215 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006216
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006217 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6218 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6219 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6220 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6221 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006223 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6224 supported:
6225 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6226 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6227 - allow
6228 - auth [realm <realm>]
6229 - cache-use <name>
6230 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6231 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6232 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6233 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6234 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6235 - disable-l7-retry
6236 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6237 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6238 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6239 - redirect <rule>
6240 - reject
6241 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6242 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6243 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6244 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6245 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6246 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6247 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6248 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6249 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6250 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6251 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6252 - set-dst <expr>
6253 - set-dst-port <expr>
6254 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6255 - set-log-level <level>
6256 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6257 - set-mark <mark>
6258 - set-method <fmt>
6259 - set-nice <nice>
6260 - set-path <fmt>
6261 - set-pathq <fmt>
6262 - set-priority-class <expr>
6263 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6264 - set-query <fmt>
6265 - set-src <expr>
6266 - set-src-port <expr>
6267 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6268 - set-tos <tos>
6269 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006270 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6271 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006272 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6273 - silent-drop
6274 - strict-mode { on | off }
6275 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6276 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6277 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6278 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6279 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6280 - use-service <service-name>
6281 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6282 - wait-for-handshake
6283 - cache-use <name>
6284
6285 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006287 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006288
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006289 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6290 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6291 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6292 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6293 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6294 a defaults section defining such rules.
6295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006296 Example:
6297 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6298 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6299 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006301 http-request allow if nagios
6302 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6303 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6304 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006306 Example:
6307 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6308 acl add path /addacl
6309 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006311 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006313 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6314 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006316 Example:
6317 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6318 acl setmap path /setmap
6319 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006321 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006323 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6324 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006326 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6327 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006329http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006331 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6334 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6335 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6336 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6337 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6338 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006340http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006342 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6343 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6344 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6345 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6346 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6347 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6348 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6349 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006351http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006354 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6359 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6360 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6361 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6362 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006363
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006364 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6365 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6366 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6367 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6368 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6369 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6370 instead.
6371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372 Example:
6373 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6374 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006375
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006376http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006377
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006378 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6381 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6384 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6385 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6386 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6387 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6388 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6389 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6390 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6391 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006393 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6394 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6395 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006396 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6397
6398 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6399 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6400 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6401 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006403http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6406 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6407 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6408 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6409 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6410 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006411
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006412http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006413
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006414 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6415 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6416 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6417 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6418 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006420http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006422 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6423 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6424 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6425 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6426 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6427 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006428
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006429http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6431 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6432 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6433 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6434 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006435
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006436 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6437 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6438 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006439 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006440 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6441 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6442 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006443 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006444 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006445
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006446http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6448 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6449 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6450
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006451http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006453
6454 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6455 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6456 pointed by <resolvers>.
6457 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6458 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6459 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6460 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6461 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6462 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6463 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6464 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6465 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6466 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6467 to 0.0.0.0.
6468
6469 Example:
6470 resolvers mydns
6471 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6472 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6473 timeout retry 1s
6474 hold valid 10s
6475 hold nx 3s
6476 hold other 3s
6477 hold obsolete 0s
6478 accepted_payload_size 8192
6479
6480 frontend fe
6481 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6482 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6483 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6484
6485 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6486 # which mean DNS resolution error
6487 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6488
6489 default_backend be
6490
6491 backend b_503
6492 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6493 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6494 # 503 error page to end users
6495
6496 backend be
6497 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6498 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6499 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6500 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6501 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6502
6503 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6504 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6505
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006506http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6507
6508 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6509 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6510 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6511 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006512 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6513 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006514
6515 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6516
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006517http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006518http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006519http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006520http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006521http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006522http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006523http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006524http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6525http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006526
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006527 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6528
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006529 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006530 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6531 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6532 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6533 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006534
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006535 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6536 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6537 the supported backend.
6538
6539 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6540 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6541 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6542 number of segments in the path.
6543
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006544 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6545 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6546 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6547 when improperly combined.
6548
6549 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6550 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6551 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6552 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6553 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6554
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006555 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006556
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006557 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6558
6559 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6560 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6561
6562 Example:
6563 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6564
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006565 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6566
6567 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6568 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6569
6570 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6571 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6572
6573 Example:
6574 - /#foo -> /
6575
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006576 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6577 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006578
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006579 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6580 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6581
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006582 Example:
6583 - /. -> /
6584 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6585 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6586 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006587
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006588 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6589 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6590
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006591 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006592 their preceding segment.
6593
6594 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6595 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6596
6597 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6598 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006599
6600 Example:
6601 - /foo/../ -> /
6602 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6603 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6604 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006605 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006606 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006607 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006608
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006609 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6610 removed as well:
6611
6612 Example:
6613 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6614 - /bar/../../ -> /
6615
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006616 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6617 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006618
6619 Example:
6620 - // -> /
6621 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6622
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006623 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6624 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6625
6626 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6627 ".", "_", and "~".
6628
6629 Example:
6630 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6631 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6632 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6633 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6634
6635 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6636 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6637
6638 Example:
6639 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6640 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6641
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006642 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006643 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006644
6645 Example:
6646 - /%6f -> /%6F
6647 - /%zz -> /%zz
6648
6649 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6650 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6651
6652 Example:
6653 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6654
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006655 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006656 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6657 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6658
6659 Example:
6660 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6661 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6662 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6667 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6668 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6669 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6670 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006672http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6675 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6676 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6677 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006679http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6680 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006681
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006682 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006683 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6684 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6685 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6686 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6687 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006688
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006689 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6690 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6691 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6692 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6693 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006694
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006695 Example:
6696 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6697
6698 # applied to:
6699 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6700
6701 # outputs:
6702 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6703
6704 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006705
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006706 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6707
6708 # applied to:
6709 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006710
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006711 # outputs:
6712 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006713
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006714http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6715 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6716
6717 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6718 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006719 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6720 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6721 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006722
6723 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6724 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6725 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6726
6727 Example:
6728 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6729 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6730
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006731 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6732 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6733 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6734 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6735
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006736http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6738
6739 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6740 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6741 query-string are replaced.
6742
6743 Example:
6744 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6745 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6746
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006747http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6748 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006750 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6751 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6752 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6753 against.
6754
6755 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6756 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6757 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006758
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006759 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6760 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6761 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6762 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6763 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6764 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6765 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6766 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6767 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006768 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6769 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006770
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006771 Example:
6772 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6773 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006774
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006775 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6776 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006778http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6779 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006780
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006781 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6782 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6783 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6784 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006785
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006786 Example:
6787 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006788
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006789 # applied to:
6790 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006791
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006792 # outputs:
6793 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006794
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006795http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6796 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6797 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006798 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006799 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6800
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006801 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006802 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6803 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006804 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006805 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006806 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006807 are followed to create the response :
6808
6809 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6810 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6811 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6812 ignored.
6813
6814 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6815 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006816 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006817 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6818 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006819
6820 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6821 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6822 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006823 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006824 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006825
6826 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6827 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6828 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006829 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006830 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006831 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006832
6833 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6834 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6835 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6836 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6837 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6838 as a raw content.
6839
6840 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6841 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6842 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6843 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6844 considered as a raw string.
6845
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006846 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006847 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6848 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6849 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6850
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006851 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6852 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006853 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006854
6855 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6856
6857 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006858 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006859 if { path /ping }
6860
6861 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6862 if { path /favicon.ico }
6863
6864 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6865 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6866 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6867
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006868http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6869
6870 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6871 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6872 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6873 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6874 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6875 at this index.
6876 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6877 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006879http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6880http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006882 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6883 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6884 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006885
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006886http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6887 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6888 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6889 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6890 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6891 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6892 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6893 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6894 at this index.
6895 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6896 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6897
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006898http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006900
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006901 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6902 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6903 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6904 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006905
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006906http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6907 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6908
6909 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6910 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6911 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6912 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6913 agent name must be used.
6914
6915 Arguments:
6916 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6917
6918 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6919 configuration.
6920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006921http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006923 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6924 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6925 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6926 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6927 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006929 Arguments:
6930 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6931 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006933 Example:
6934 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6935 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006937 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6938 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006941
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006942 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6943 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6944 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006946 Arguments:
6947 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6948 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006950 Example:
6951 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6952 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006954 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6955 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6956 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006958http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006960 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6961 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6962 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6963 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6964 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006966 Example:
6967 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6968 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6969 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6970 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6971 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6972 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6973 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6974 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6975 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006977http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006979 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6980 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6981 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6982 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6983 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006985http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6986 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006988 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6989 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6990 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6991 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6992 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6993 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6994 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6995 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6996 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006998http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006999
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007000 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7001 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7002 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7003 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7004 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7005 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7006 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007007 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7008 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007010http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007012 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7013 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7014 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007016http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007018 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7019 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7020 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7021 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7022 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7023 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7024 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7025 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007027http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007029 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7030 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7031 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7032 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7033 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7034 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007036 Example :
7037 # prepend the host name before the path
7038 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007039
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007040http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7041
7042 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7043 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7044 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007046http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7049 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7050 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7051 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7052 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007054http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007056 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7057 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7058 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7059 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7060 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7061 values have higher priority.
7062 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7063 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7064 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7065 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7066 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007068http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007070 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7071 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7072 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7073 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7074 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7075 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7076 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007078 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007079
7080 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007081 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7082 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007084http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7085 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7086 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7087 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007088 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7089 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007090
7091 Arguments :
7092 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7093 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007094
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007095 See also "option forwardfor".
7096
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007097 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007098 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7099 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7100
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007101 # After the masking this will track connections
7102 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7103 http-request track-sc0 src
7104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007105 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7106 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7107
7108http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7109
7110 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7111 expression.
7112
7113 Arguments:
7114 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7115 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007116
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007117 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007118 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7119 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7120
7121 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7122 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7123 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7124
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007125http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007126 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7127
7128 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7129 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7130 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7131 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7132 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7133
7134 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7135 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7136 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7137 results.
7138
7139 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007140 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7141 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007143http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7144
7145 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7146 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7147 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7148 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7149 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7150 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7151 information from the request.
7152
7153 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7154
7155http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7156
7157 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7158 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
7159 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
7160 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
7161 path and the query string.
7162 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7163
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007164http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7165http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007166
7167 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7168 inline.
7169
7170 Arguments:
7171 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7172 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7173 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7174 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7175 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7176 (request and response)
7177 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7178 processing
7179 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7180 processing
7181 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7182 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7183 and '_'.
7184
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007185 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7186 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007187 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007188 conditions.
7189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7191 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007192
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007193 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7194 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7195
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007196 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007197 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007198 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007200http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7201
7202 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7203 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7204 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7205 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7206 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7207 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7208 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7209 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7210 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7211 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7212 action.
7213 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7214 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7215 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7216 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7217 you fully understand how it works.
7218
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007219http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007220
7221 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7222 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7223 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7224 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7225 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007226 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007227 processing.
7228
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007229 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007230 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7231 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7232 rules evaluation.
7233
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007234http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7235http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7236 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7237 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7238 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7239 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007240
7241 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7242 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7243 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007244 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7245 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7246 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7247 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7248 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7249 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007250 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007251 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7252 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7253 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007254 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007255 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7256 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7257 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7258 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7259 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007260
7261http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7262http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7264
7265 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7266 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7267 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7268 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007269 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007270 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7271 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7272 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7273 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7274 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7275 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7276 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7277
7278 Arguments :
7279 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7280 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7281 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7282 select which table entry to update the counters.
7283
7284 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7285 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7286 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7287 that table until the session ends.
7288
7289 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7290 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7291 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7292 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7293 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7294 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7295 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7296 useful information.
7297
7298 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7299 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7300 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7301 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7302 checks that make use of it.
7303
7304http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7305
7306 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007307
7308 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007309 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007310
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007311http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7312
7313 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7314 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7315 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7316 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7317 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7318 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7319
7320 Arguments :
7321 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7322
7323 Example:
7324 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7325
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007326http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7327 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7328
7329 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7330 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7331 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7332 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7333 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7334 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7335 http-buffer-request".
7336
7337 Arguments :
7338
7339 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7340 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7341
7342 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007343 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007344 bytes.
7345
7346 Example:
7347 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7348
7349 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007351http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007353 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7354 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7355 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007356
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007357
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007358http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007359 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7360
7361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007362 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007363
7364 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7365 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7366 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7367 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7368 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7369 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7370
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007371 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7372 supported:
7373 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7374 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7375 - allow
7376 - cache-store <name>
7377 - capture <sample> id <id>
7378 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7379 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7380 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7381 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7382 - redirect <rule>
7383 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7384 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7385 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7386 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7387 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7388 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7389 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7390 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7391 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7392 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7393 - set-log-level <level>
7394 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7395 - set-mark <mark>
7396 - set-nice <nice>
7397 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7398 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007399 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7400 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007401 - silent-drop
7402 - strict-mode { on | off }
7403 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7404 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7405 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7406 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7407 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7408
7409 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007410
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007411 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007412
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007413 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7414 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7415 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7416 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7417 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7418 a defaults section defining such rules.
7419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007420 Example:
7421 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007423 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007424
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007425 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7426 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007428 Example:
7429 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007431 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007433 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7434 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007436 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7437 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007439http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007441 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7442 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007444http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007446 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007447 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7448 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007450http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007452 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7453 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007454
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007455http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007456
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007457 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007459http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007461 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7462 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7463 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7464 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7465 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7466 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7467 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007469 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7470 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7471 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7472 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7473 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007474
7475 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7476 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7477 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7478 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007480http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007482 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7483 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007484
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007485http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007486
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007487 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7488 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007490http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007491
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007492 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7493 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007494
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007495http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7496http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7497 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7498 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7499 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7500 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007501
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007502 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7503 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7504 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007505 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007506 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7507 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7508 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007509 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007510 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007511
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007512http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007513
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007514 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7515 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7516 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7517 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7518 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7519 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007520
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007521http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7522 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007523
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007524 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7525 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007526
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007527 Example:
7528 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007530 # applied to:
7531 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007532
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007533 # outputs:
7534 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007536 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007537
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007538http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007540
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007541 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007542 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007543
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007544 Example:
7545 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007546
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007547 # applied to:
7548 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007550 # outputs:
7551 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007552
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007553http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7554 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7555 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007556 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007557 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7558
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007559 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7560 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7561 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007562
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007563http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007564http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7565http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007566
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007567 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7568 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7569 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7570 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007571
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007572http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007574http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007576http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7577 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007578
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007579 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7580 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7581 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007582
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007583http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7584 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007585
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007586 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7587 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007589http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007590
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007591 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7592 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7593 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7594 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007596http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7597
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007598 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7599 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007600
7601http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7602
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007603 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7604 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007605
7606http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7607
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007608 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7609 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7610 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007611
7612http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7613
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007614 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7615 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007616
7617http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7618 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7619
7620 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7621 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7622 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7623 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007624
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007625 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007626 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7627 http-response set-status 431
7628 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7629 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007631http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007633 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007634 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7635 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007636
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007637http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7638http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007639
7640 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007641 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7642 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007644http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007646 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7647 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007648 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7649 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007650
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007651http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007652
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007653 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7654 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007655
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007656http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7657http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7658http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007659
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007660 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7661 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7662 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007663
7664http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7665
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007666 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007667 about <var-name>.
7668
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007669http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7671
7672 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007673 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7674 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007675
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007676
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007677http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7678 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7679
7680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7681 yes | no | yes | yes
7682
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007683 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007684 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7685 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7686 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007687
7688 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7689
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007690 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7691 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7692 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7693 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7694 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7695 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7696 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007697 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007698 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7699 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007700
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007701 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7702 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7703 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7704 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7705 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7706 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7707 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007708 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7709 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7710 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7711 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7712 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7713 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007714
7715 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7716 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7717 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7718 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7719 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7720 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7721 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7722 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007723 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007724 downsides of rare connection failures.
7725
7726 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7727 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7728 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7729 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7730 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7731 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007732 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007733 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7734 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7735 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7736 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7737 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7738
7739 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007740 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7741 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7742 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7743 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007744
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007745 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7746 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007747
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007748 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007749
7750 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7751 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7752 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7753
7754 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7755
7756
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007757http-send-name-header [<header>]
7758 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007761 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007762 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7763
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007764 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7765 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7766 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7767 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7768 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7769 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7770 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7771 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7772 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7773 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7774 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7775 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7776 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7777 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7778 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7779 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007780
7781 See also : "server"
7782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007783id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007784 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7786 no | yes | yes | yes
7787 Arguments : none
7788
7789 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7790 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7791 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007792
7793
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007794ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7795 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007797 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007798
7799 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7800 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7801 and running).
7802
7803 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7804 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7805 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007806 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007807 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7808
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007809 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7810 "unless" condition is met.
7811
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007812 Example:
7813 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7814 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7815 ignore-persist if url_static
7816
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007817 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7818
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007819load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7820 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7822 yes | no | yes | yes
7823
7824 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7825 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7826 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007827 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007828 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007829 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7830 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7831 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007833 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007834 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007835 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007836
7837 Arguments:
7838 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7839 named "server-state-file".
7840
7841 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7842 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7843 name is used as a file name.
7844
7845 none don't load any stat for this backend
7846
7847 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007848 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7849 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7850 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007851 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007852 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007853
7854 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7855 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7856
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007857 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007858
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007859 global
7860 stats socket /tmp/socket
7861 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007862
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007863 defaults
7864 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007865
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007866 backend bk
7867 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7868 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007869
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007870
7871 Then one can run :
7872
7873 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7874
7875 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7876
7877 1
7878 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7879 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7880 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7881
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007882 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007883
7884 global
7885 stats socket /tmp/socket
7886 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7887
7888 defaults
7889 load-server-state-from-file local
7890
7891 backend bk
7892 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7893 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7894
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007895
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007896 Then one can run :
7897
7898 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7899
7900 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7901
7902 1
7903 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7904 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7905 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7906
7907 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7908 "show servers state"
7909
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007910
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007911log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007912log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007913 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007914no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007915 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7917 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007918
7919 Prefix :
7920 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7921 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7922 prefix does not allow arguments.
7923
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007924 Arguments :
7925 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7926 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7927 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7928 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7929 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7930 parameter.
7931
7932 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7933 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7934
7935 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7936 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7937 standard syslog port).
7938
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007939 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7940 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7941 standard syslog port).
7942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007943 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7944 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7945 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007946 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007947
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007948 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7949 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7950 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7951 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7952 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7953 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7954 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7955 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7956 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7957 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7958 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7959 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007960 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007961 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7962 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7963 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007964 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7965 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007966
7967 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7968 and "fd@2", see above.
7969
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007970 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7971 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7972 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7973 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7974 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7975 having the logs instantly available.
7976
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007977 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7978 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7979 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7980
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007981 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7982 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007983
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007984 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7985 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7986 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7987 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7988 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7989 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7990 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7991 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7992 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7993 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007994 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007995
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007996 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7997 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7998 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7999 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8000 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8001
8002 <sample_size>
8003 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8004 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8005 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8006 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8007 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8008
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008009 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8010 one of the following :
8011
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008012 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8013 field is stripped. This is the default.
8014 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8015 rfc3164.
8016
8017 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008018 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8019
8020 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8021 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8022
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008023 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8024 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8025 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8026 designed to be used with a local log server.
8027
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008028 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8029 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8030 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8031 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8032 systemd logger consumes.
8033
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008034 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8035 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8036 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8037 used with a local log server.
8038
8039 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8040 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8041 designed to be used with a local log server.
8042
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008043 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8044 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8045 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8046 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8047
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8049
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008050 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8051 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8052 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8053
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008054 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8055 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8056 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8057 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008058
8059 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8060 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8061 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008062 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8063 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8064 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8065 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8066 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008067
8068 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8069
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008070 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8071 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8072 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008073
8074 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8075 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8076 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8077 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8078
8079 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8080 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008081
8082 Example :
8083 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008084 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8085 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8086 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008087 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008088 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8089 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008090 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008092
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008093log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008094 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8096 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008097
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008098 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8099 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8100 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8101 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8102 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008103 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8104 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008105
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008106 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8107 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008108
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008109log-format-sd <string>
8110 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | yes | yes | no
8113
8114 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8115 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8116 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8117 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8118 which covers the log format string in depth.
8119
8120 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8121 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8122
8123 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8124 log format to "rfc5424".
8125
8126 Example :
8127 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8128
8129
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008130log-tag <string>
8131 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 yes | yes | yes | yes
8134
8135 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8136 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008137 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008138 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8139 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8140 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8141 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8142 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8143 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008144
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008145max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8146 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8148 yes | no | yes | yes
8149
8150 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8151 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8152 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8153 servers.
8154
8155 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008156 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008157 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8158 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8159 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008160 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008161 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8162 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8163 picking a different server.
8164
8165 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8166 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8167 even if they have to be queued.
8168
8169 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8170 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8171
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008172max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8173 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8174 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8175 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008177maxconn <conns>
8178 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 yes | yes | yes | no
8181 Arguments :
8182 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8183 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8184 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8185 closes.
8186
8187 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008188 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008189 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8190 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008191 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8192 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8193 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8194 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008195
8196 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8197 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8198 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8199
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008200 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8201 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008202
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008203 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8204
8205
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008206mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008207 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8209 yes | yes | yes | yes
8210 Arguments :
8211 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8212 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8213 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8214 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8215
8216 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8217 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8218 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8219 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8220 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8221
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008222 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8223 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8224 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008225
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008226 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008227 defaults http_instances
8228 mode http
8229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008230
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008231monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008232 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008235 Arguments :
8236 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8237 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008238 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008239 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8240 backend and its backup.
8241
8242 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8243 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8244 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8245 servers in a list of backends.
8246
8247 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8248 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8249 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008250 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008251 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8252 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008253 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008254 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8255 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008256
8257 Example:
8258 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008259 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008260 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8261 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8262 monitor-uri /site_alive
8263 monitor fail if site_dead
8264
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008265 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008266
8267
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008268monitor-uri <uri>
8269 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 yes | yes | yes | no
8272 Arguments :
8273 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8274 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8275
8276 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8277 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8278 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8279 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8280 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8281 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8282 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8283 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8284
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008285 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008286 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8287 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8288 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8289 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8290 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8291 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008292
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008293 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8294 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8295 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8296 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8297
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008298 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008299 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008300 frontend www
8301 mode http
8302 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8303
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008304 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008306
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008307option abortonclose
8308no option abortonclose
8309 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8311 yes | no | yes | yes
8312 Arguments : none
8313
8314 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8315 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8316 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8317 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008318 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008319 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8320 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8321 encountered while delivering the response.
8322
8323 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8324 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8325 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8326 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8327 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8328 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008329 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008330 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008331 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008332 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8333 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8334 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8335
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8337 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008338 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8339 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8340 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8341 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8342 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8343 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008344 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008345
8346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8348
8349 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8350
8351
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008352option accept-invalid-http-request
8353no option accept-invalid-http-request
8354 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8356 yes | yes | yes | no
8357 Arguments : none
8358
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008359 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008360 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008361 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008362 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8363 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8364 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8365 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8366 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008367 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8368 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8369 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8370 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008371 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008372 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008373 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8374 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8375 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008376
8377 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8378 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8379 been confirmed.
8380
8381 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8382 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008383 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8384 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008385 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8386
8387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8389
8390 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8391 stats socket.
8392
8393
8394option accept-invalid-http-response
8395no option accept-invalid-http-response
8396 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 yes | no | yes | yes
8399 Arguments : none
8400
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008401 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008402 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008403 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008404 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8405 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8406 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8407 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8408 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008409 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8410 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8411 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008412
8413 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8414 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8415 been confirmed.
8416
8417 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8418 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8419 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8420 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8421
8422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8424
8425 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8426 stats socket.
8427
8428
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008429option allbackups
8430no option allbackups
8431 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments : none
8435
8436 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8437 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8438 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8439 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8440 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8441 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8442 order between the backup servers anymore.
8443
8444 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8445 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8446
8447 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8448 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8449
8450
8451option checkcache
8452no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008453 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8455 yes | no | yes | yes
8456 Arguments : none
8457
8458 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8459 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008460 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008461 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8462 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008463 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008464
8465 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008466 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008467 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008468 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8469 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008470 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008471 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008472 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8473 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008474 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008475 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8476 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008477 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008478 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8479 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8480 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8481 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8482 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8483 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8484 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8485 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8486 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8487
8488 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008489 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8490 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8491 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8492 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008493
8494 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8495 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008496 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008497 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008498
8499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8501
8502
8503option clitcpka
8504no option clitcpka
8505 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8507 yes | yes | yes | no
8508 Arguments : none
8509
8510 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8511 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008512 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008513 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8514
8515 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8516 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8517 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8518 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8519
8520 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8521 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8522 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8523 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8524 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8525
8526 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8527
8528 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8529 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8530 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8531
8532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8534
8535 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8536
8537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008538option contstats
8539 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | yes | yes | no
8542 Arguments : none
8543
8544 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8545 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8546 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008547 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008548 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8549 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8550 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8551 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8552 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008553
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008554option disable-h2-upgrade
8555no option disable-h2-upgrade
8556 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8557 connection.
8558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8559 yes | yes | yes | no
8560 Arguments : none
8561
8562 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8563 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8564 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8565 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008566 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8567 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8568 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8569 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8570 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8571 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008572
8573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008575
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008576option dontlog-normal
8577no option dontlog-normal
8578 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8580 yes | yes | yes | no
8581 Arguments : none
8582
8583 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8584 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8585 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8586 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8587 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8588 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8589 logged.
8590
8591 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8592 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8593 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008595 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008596 logging.
8597
8598
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008599option dontlognull
8600no option dontlognull
8601 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8603 yes | yes | yes | no
8604 Arguments : none
8605
8606 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8607 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8608 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8609 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8610 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8611 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008612 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8613 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8614 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008615
8616 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008617 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008618 would not be logged.
8619
8620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8622
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008623 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008624 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008625
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008626
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008627option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008628 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8630 yes | yes | yes | yes
8631 Arguments :
8632 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8633 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008634 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008635 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008636
8637 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8638 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8639 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8640 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8641 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8642 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8643 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008644 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8645 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8646 possible that the client has already brought one.
8647
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008648 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008649 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008650 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008651 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008653 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008654
8655 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8656 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8657 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8658 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8659 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8660 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008661 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008662
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008663 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8664 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008665 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008666 are under the control of the end-user.
8667
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008668 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008669 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8670 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008671 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8672 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8673 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008674
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008675 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008676 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8677 frontend www
8678 mode http
8679 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8680
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008681 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8682 backend www
8683 mode http
8684 option forwardfor header X-Client
8685
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008686 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008687 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008688
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008689
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008690option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8691no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8692 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8694 yes | yes | yes | no
8695 Arguments : none
8696
8697 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8698 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8699 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8700 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8701 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8702 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8703 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8704
8705 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8706 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8707 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8708 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8709 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8710 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8711 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8712 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8713 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8714 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8715
8716 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8717
8718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8720
8721 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8722 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8723
8724
8725option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8726no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8727 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8729 yes | no | yes | yes
8730 Arguments : none
8731
8732 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8733 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8734 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8735 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8736 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8737 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8738 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8739
8740 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8741 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8742 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8743 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8744 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8745 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8746 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8747 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8748 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8749 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8750
8751 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8752
8753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8755
8756 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8757 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8758
8759
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008760option http-buffer-request
8761no option http-buffer-request
8762 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8764 yes | yes | yes | yes
8765 Arguments : none
8766
8767 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8768 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8769 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8770 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8771 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8772 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008773 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8774 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8775 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8776 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008777
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008778 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8779 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008780
8781
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008782option http-ignore-probes
8783no option http-ignore-probes
8784 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8786 yes | yes | yes | no
8787 Arguments : none
8788
8789 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8790 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8791 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8792 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8793 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8794 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8795 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8796 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8797 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8799 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008800 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8801
8802 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8803 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8804 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8805 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8806 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8807 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8808 are often the only way to detect them.
8809
8810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8812
8813 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8814
8815
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008816option http-keep-alive
8817no option http-keep-alive
8818 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8820 yes | yes | yes | yes
8821 Arguments : none
8822
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008823 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8824 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008825 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8826 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008827 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8828 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8829 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008830
8831 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8832 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008833 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8834 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8835 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8836 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8837 situations where this option may be useful :
8838
8839 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008841
8842 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8843 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8844
8845 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8846 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8847 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8848 request.
8849
8850 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8851 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008852 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8853 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8854 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008855
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008856 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8857 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8858 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8859 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8860 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8861 not set.
8862
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008863 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8864 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8865 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008866
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008867 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008868 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008869 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008870
8871
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008872option http-no-delay
8873no option http-no-delay
8874 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8876 yes | yes | yes | yes
8877 Arguments : none
8878
8879 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8880 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8881 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8882 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8883 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8884 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8885 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008886 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008887 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8888 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8889 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8890 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8891 affected.
8892
8893 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8894 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8895 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8896 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8897 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8898 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8899 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8900 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8901 latency environments.
8902
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008903 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8904
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008905
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008906option http-pretend-keepalive
8907no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008908 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008910 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008911 Arguments : none
8912
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008913 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008914 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8915 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8916 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008917 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008918 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8919 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8920 consider the response complete.
8921
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008922 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008923 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008924 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008925 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008926 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008927 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8928
8929 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8930 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8931 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8932 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008933 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8934 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008935 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8936
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008937 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8938 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8939 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8940 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8941 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8942 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008943
8944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8946
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008947 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008948 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008949
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008950option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8951 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8952 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 yes | yes | yes | yes
8955 Arguments :
8956 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8957 with no FastCGI application configured.
8958
8959 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8960 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8961 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8962
8963 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8964 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8965
8966 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8967 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8968 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8969 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8970 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8971 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8972 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8973 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8974
8975 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8976 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008977
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008978option http-server-close
8979no option http-server-close
8980 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | yes | yes | yes
8983 Arguments : none
8984
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008985 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8986 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8987 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8988 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008989 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8990 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8991 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8992 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8993 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8994 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8995 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8996 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8997 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8998 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8999 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009000
9001 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9002 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9003 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9004 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009005 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9006 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009007
9008 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9009 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009010 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9011 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9012 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009013
9014 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9015 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9016
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009017 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
9018 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009019
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009020option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009021no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009022 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9024 yes | yes | yes | no
9025 Arguments : none
9026
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009027 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009028 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9029 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9030 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9031 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9032 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009033 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009034
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009035 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009036 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009037 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9038 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9039 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009040
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009041 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9042 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9043 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9044 front of an existing proxy.
9045
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009046 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9047
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009048 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009049
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009050option httpchk
9051option httpchk <uri>
9052option httpchk <method> <uri>
9053option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009054 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | no | yes | yes
9057 Arguments :
9058 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9059 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9060 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9061 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9062 ones.
9063
9064 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9065 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9066 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9067
9068 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9069 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9070 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009071 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009072
9073 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9074 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9075 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9076 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9077 the lack of any response.
9078
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009079 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9080 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9081 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9082 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9083
9084 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9085 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9086 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009087
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009088 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9089 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009090 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009091 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009092 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009093
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009094 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
9095 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
9096 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
9097 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
9098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009099 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009100 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9101 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9102 backend https_relay
9103 mode tcp
9104 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9105 http-check send hdr Host www
9106 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009107
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009108 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9109 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9110 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009111
9112
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009113option httpclose
9114no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009115 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9117 yes | yes | yes | yes
9118 Arguments : none
9119
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009120 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9121 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9122 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9123 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009124 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009125
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009126 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9127 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009128 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009129 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9130 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009131
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009132 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9133 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9134 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009135
9136 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9137 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009138 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9139 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9140 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009141
9142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9144
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009145 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009146
9147
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009148option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009149 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009151 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009152 Arguments :
9153 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9154 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9155 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009156 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009157 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009158
9159 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9160 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9161 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9162 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9163 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9164 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9165 ports.
9166
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009167 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9168 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009169
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009170 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009172 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009173
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009174option httpslog
9175 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9177 yes | yes | yes | no
9178
9179 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9180 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9181 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9182 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9183 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9184 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9185 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9186
9187 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9188
9189 See also : section 8 about logging.
9190
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009191
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009192option independent-streams
9193no option independent-streams
9194 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9196 yes | yes | yes | yes
9197 Arguments : none
9198
9199 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9200 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9201 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9202 receive data or not.
9203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009204 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009205 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9206 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9207 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9208 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9209 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9210 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9211 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9212 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9213 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9214 socket buffers.
9215
9216 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9217 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9218 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9219 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9220 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9221
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009222 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009223
9224
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009225option ldap-check
9226 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9228 yes | no | yes | yes
9229 Arguments : none
9230
9231 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9232 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9233 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9234 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9235
9236 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9237 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9238
9239 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9240 configure it.
9241
9242 Example :
9243 option ldap-check
9244
9245 See also : "option httpchk"
9246
9247
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009248option external-check
9249 Use external processes for server health checks
9250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9251 yes | no | yes | yes
9252
9253 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9254 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9255 command".
9256
9257 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9258
9259 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9260
9261
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009262option idle-close-on-response
9263no option idle-close-on-response
9264 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9266 yes | yes | yes | no
9267 Arguments : none
9268
9269 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9270 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9271 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9272 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9273 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9274 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9275 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9276 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9277 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9278
9279 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9280 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9281
9282 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9283 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9284 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9285 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9286
9287 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9288 "hard-stop-after"
9289
9290
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009291option log-health-checks
9292no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009293 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9295 yes | no | yes | yes
9296 Arguments : none
9297
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009298 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9299 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9300 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009301
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009302 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9303 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9304 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9305 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9306 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009308 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009309 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009310
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009311 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9312 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9313 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009314
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009315
9316option log-separate-errors
9317no option log-separate-errors
9318 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9320 yes | yes | yes | no
9321 Arguments : none
9322
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009323 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009324 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9325 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9326 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9327 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9328 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9329 provides very important information.
9330
9331 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9332 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9333 error logs.
9334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009335 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009336 logging.
9337
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009338
9339option logasap
9340no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009341 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 yes | yes | yes | no
9344 Arguments : none
9345
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009346 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9347 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9348 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9349 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9350
9351 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9352 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9353 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9354 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9355 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009356 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009357 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9358 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9359 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9360 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009361 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009362
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009363 Examples :
9364 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9365 mode http
9366 option httplog
9367 option logasap
9368 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9369
9370 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9371 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9372 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9373 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009375 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009376 logging.
9377
9378
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009379option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009380 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9382 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009383 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009384 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9385 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009386 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9387 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009388
9389 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9390 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009391 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009392 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009393 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9394 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9395 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009396
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009397 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9398 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9399 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009400
9401 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009402 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009403 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9404 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9405 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9406 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9407 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9408 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9409 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9410
9411 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9412 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009413
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009414 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009415
9416 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9417 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9418 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9419 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009420 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009421 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009422
9423 See also: "option httpchk"
9424
9425
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009426option nolinger
9427no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009428 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009431 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009433 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009434 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9435 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9436 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9437 connections.
9438
9439 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9440 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009441 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9442 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9443 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9444 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9445 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9446 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9447 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9448 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9449 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9450 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9451 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9452 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9453 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009454
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009455 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9456 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9457 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9458 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9459 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009460
9461 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9462 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009463 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009464 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009465 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009466
9467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9469
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009470 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9471 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009472
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009473option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9474 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | yes | yes | yes
9477 Arguments :
9478 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9479 matching <network>
9480 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9481 header name.
9482
9483 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9484 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9485 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9486 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9487 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9488 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9489 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9490 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9491 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9492 possible that the client has already brought one.
9493
9494 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9495 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9496 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9497 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9498 header and requires different one.
9499
9500 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9501 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9502 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009503 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9504 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9505 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9506 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9507 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009508
9509 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9510 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9511 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9512 both are defined.
9513
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009514 Examples :
9515 # Original Destination address
9516 frontend www
9517 mode http
9518 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9519
9520 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9521 backend www
9522 mode http
9523 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9524
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009525 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009526
9527
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009528option persist
9529no option persist
9530 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009533 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009534
9535 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9536 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9537 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9538 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9539 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9540 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9541 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9542 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9543 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9544 redirected to another valid server.
9545
9546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9548
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009549 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009550
9551
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009552option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9553 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9555 yes | no | yes | yes
9556 Arguments :
9557 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9558 PostgreSQL server.
9559
9560 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9561 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9562 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9563 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9564
9565 See also: "option httpchk"
9566
9567
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009568option prefer-last-server
9569no option prefer-last-server
9570 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9572 yes | no | yes | yes
9573 Arguments : none
9574
9575 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009576 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009577 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9578 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009579 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009580 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009581 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009582 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9583 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009584 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009585 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009586 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9587 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9588 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009589 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9590 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9591 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009592
9593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9595
9596 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9597
9598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009599option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009600option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009601no option redispatch
9602 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9604 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009605 Arguments :
9606 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9607 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9608 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009609 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009610 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009611 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009612 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9613 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9614 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009616
9617 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9618 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9619 be able to access the service anymore.
9620
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009621 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9622 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009623
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009624 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9625 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9626 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9627 following order:
9628
9629 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9630
9631 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9632 list, or
9633
9634 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9635
9636 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9637 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9638
9639 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9640 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9641 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9642 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9643
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009644 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009645 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9646 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9650
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009651 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009652
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009653
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009654option redis-check
9655 Use redis health checks for server testing
9656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9657 yes | no | yes | yes
9658 Arguments : none
9659
9660 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9661 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9662 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9663 find the "+PONG" response message.
9664
9665 Example :
9666 option redis-check
9667
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009668 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009669
9670
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009671option smtpchk
9672option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9673 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9675 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009676 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009677 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009678 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009679 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9680
9681 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9682 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9683 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9684
9685 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9686 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9687 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9688 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9689 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9690 dead server.
9691
9692 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9693 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009694 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009695 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9696
9697 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9698 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9699 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9700 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009701 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009702
9703 Example :
9704 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9705
9706 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009709option socket-stats
9710no option socket-stats
9711
9712 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9714 yes | yes | yes | no
9715
9716 Arguments : none
9717
9718
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009719option splice-auto
9720no option splice-auto
9721 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9723 yes | yes | yes | yes
9724 Arguments : none
9725
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009726 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009727 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009728 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009729 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009730 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009731 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9732 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9733 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9734 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9735
9736 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9737 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9738 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9739 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9740 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9741 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9742 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9743 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9744 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9745 keyword.
9746
9747 Example :
9748 option splice-auto
9749
9750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9752
9753 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9754 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9755
9756
9757option splice-request
9758no option splice-request
9759 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9761 yes | yes | yes | yes
9762 Arguments : none
9763
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009764 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009765 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009766 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9767 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9768 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9769 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9770
9771 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9772
9773 Example :
9774 option splice-request
9775
9776 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9777 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9778
9779 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9780 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9781
9782
9783option splice-response
9784no option splice-response
9785 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9787 yes | yes | yes | yes
9788 Arguments : none
9789
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009790 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009791 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009792 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9793 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9794 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9795 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9796
9797 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9798
9799 Example :
9800 option splice-response
9801
9802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9804
9805 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9806 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9807
9808
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009809option spop-check
9810 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9812 no | no | no | yes
9813 Arguments : none
9814
9815 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9816 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9817 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9818 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9819
9820 Example :
9821 option spop-check
9822
9823 See also : "option httpchk"
9824
9825
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009826option srvtcpka
9827no option srvtcpka
9828 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9830 yes | no | yes | yes
9831 Arguments : none
9832
9833 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9834 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009836 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9837
9838 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9839 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9840 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9841 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9842
9843 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9844 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9845 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9846 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9847 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9848
9849 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9850
9851 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9852 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9853 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9854
9855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9857
9858 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9859
9860
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009861option ssl-hello-chk
9862 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9864 yes | no | yes | yes
9865 Arguments : none
9866
9867 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9868 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9869 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9870 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9871 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9872 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9873 hello message.
9874
9875 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9876 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9877 messages, which is appreciable.
9878
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009879 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009880 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9881 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009882
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009883 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9884
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009885
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009886option tcp-check
9887 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9889 yes | no | yes | yes
9890
9891 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9892 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9893
9894 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9895 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9896 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9897
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009898 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009899 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9900 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9901 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9902 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9903 only.
9904
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009905 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009906 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009907 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9908 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9909 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9910
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009911 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009912 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9913 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009914 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009915 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9916 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9917 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9918 the respective protocols.
9919 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009920 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009921
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009922 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009923
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009924 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9925 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9926 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9927 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009928
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009929 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9930 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9931 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009932
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009933
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009934 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009935 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009936 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009937 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009939 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009940 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009941 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009942
9943 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9944 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009945 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009946 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009947 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009948 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009949 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009950 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009951 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9952 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009953 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009954 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9955 tcp-check expect string +OK
9956
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009957 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009958 (send many headers before analyzing)
9959 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009960 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009961 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9962 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9963 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9964 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009965 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009966
9967
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009968 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009969
9970
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009971option tcp-smart-accept
9972no option tcp-smart-accept
9973 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9975 yes | yes | yes | no
9976 Arguments : none
9977
9978 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9979 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9980 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9981 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9982 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9983 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9984
9985 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9986 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9987 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9988 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9989
9990 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9991 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9992 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009993 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009994
9995 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9996 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9997 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9998
9999 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10000 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10001 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10002
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010003 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10004
10005
10006option tcp-smart-connect
10007no option tcp-smart-connect
10008 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10010 yes | no | yes | yes
10011 Arguments : none
10012
10013 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10014 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10015 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10016 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10017 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10018
10019 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10020 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10021 complex.
10022
10023 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10024 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10025 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10026
10027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10029
10030 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10031
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010032
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010033option tcpka
10034 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | yes | yes | yes
10037 Arguments : none
10038
10039 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10040 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010041 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010042 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10043
10044 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10045 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10046 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10047 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10048
10049 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10050 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10051 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10052 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10053 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10054
10055 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10056
10057 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10058 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10059 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10060 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10061 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10062 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10063 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10064 backends.
10065
10066 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10067
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010068
10069option tcplog
10070 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010072 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010073 Arguments : none
10074
10075 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10076 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10077 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10078 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10079 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10080 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10081 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10082 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10083
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010084 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010086 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010087
10088
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010089option transparent
10090no option transparent
10091 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010093 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010094 Arguments : none
10095
10096 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10097 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10098 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10099 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10100 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10101 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10102 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10103 appropriate server.
10104
10105 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10106 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10107
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010108 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010109 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010110
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010111
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010112external-check command <command>
10113 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10115 yes | no | yes | yes
10116
10117 Arguments :
10118 <command> is the external command to run
10119
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010120 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10121
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010122 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010123
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010124 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10125 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10126 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10127 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10128 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10129 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010130
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010131 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10132
10133 Environment variables :
10134 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10135 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10136
10137 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10138
10139 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10140
10141 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10142 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10143 for a UNIX socket).
10144
10145 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10146
10147 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10148
10149 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10150
10151 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10152
10153 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10154
10155 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10156 socket).
10157
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010158 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10159
10160 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10161 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10162 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10163 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10164 TCP server).
10165
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010166 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10167 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10168
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010169 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10170
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010171 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10172 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10173 failed.
10174
10175 Example :
10176 external-check command /bin/true
10177
10178 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10179
10180
10181external-check path <path>
10182 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10184 yes | no | yes | yes
10185
10186 Arguments :
10187 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10188
10189 The default path is "".
10190
10191 Example :
10192 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10193
10194 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10195 "external-check command"
10196
10197
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010198persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010199persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010200 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10202 yes | no | yes | yes
10203 Arguments :
10204 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010205 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10206 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010207
10208 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10209 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010210 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010211 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10212 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10213 forwarded to this server.
10214
10215 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10216 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10217 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010218 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010219 a single "listen" section.
10220
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010221 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10222 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10223 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10224
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010225 Example :
10226 listen tse-farm
10227 bind :3389
10228 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10229 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10230 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10231 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10232 persist rdp-cookie
10233 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010234 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010235 balance rdp-cookie
10236 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10237 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10238
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010239 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010240
10241
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010242rate-limit sessions <rate>
10243 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10245 yes | yes | yes | no
10246 Arguments :
10247 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10248 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10249
10250 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10251 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10252 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010253 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010254 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10255 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10256
10257 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10258 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10259 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10260 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10261
10262 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10263 listen smtp
10264 mode tcp
10265 bind :25
10266 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010267 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010268
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010269 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10270 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10271 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010272
10273 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10274
10275
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010276redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10277redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10278redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010279 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10281 no | yes | yes | yes
10282
10283 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010284 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010285
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010286 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010287 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010288 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10289 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10290 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010291
10292 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10293 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10294 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10295 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10296 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010297 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10298 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10299 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10300 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010301
10302 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10303 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10304 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10305 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10306 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10307 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010308 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010309 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010310 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10311 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10312 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010313
10314 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010315 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10316 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10317 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010318 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010319 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10320 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10321 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10322 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010323
10324 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010326
10327 - "drop-query"
10328 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10329 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10330 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10331 with a location-type redirect.
10332
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010333 - "append-slash"
10334 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10335 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10336 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10337 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10338
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010339 - "ignore-empty"
10340 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10341 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10342 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10343 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10344 of known paths using a simple map.
10345
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010346 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10347 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10348 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10349 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10350 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10351 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10352 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10353
10354 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10355 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10356 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10357 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10358 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10359 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10360 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010361
10362 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10363 acl clear dst_port 80
10364 acl secure dst_port 8080
10365 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010366 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010367 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010368 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10369
10370 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010371 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10372 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10373 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010374 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010375
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010376 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10377 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10378 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10379
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010380 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010381 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010382
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010383 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010384 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10385 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10386 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010387
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010388 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10389 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10390 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010392 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010393
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010394
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010395retries <value>
10396 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10398 yes | no | yes | yes
10399 Arguments :
10400 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10401 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10402 default value is 3.
10403
10404 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10405 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10406 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10407
10408 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010409 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10410 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010411
10412 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10413 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10414
10415 See also : "option redispatch"
10416
10417
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010418retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010419 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10420 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10421 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10423 yes | no | yes | yes
10424 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010425 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10426 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10427 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10428 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10429 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010430
10431 none never retry
10432
10433 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10434 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10435
10436 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10437 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10438 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10439 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10440 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10441 processing the request.
10442
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010443 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10444 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10445 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10446 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10447 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10448 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10449 overflow attack for example).
10450
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010451 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10452 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10453 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10454 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10455 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10456 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10457 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10458 amplify denial of service attacks.
10459
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010460 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10461 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10462 considered to be safe to retry.
10463
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010464 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10465 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10466 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10467 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10468 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010469
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010470 all-retryable-errors
10471 retry request for any error that are considered
10472 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10473 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10474 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10475
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010476 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10477 not cumulative.
10478
10479 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10480 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10481 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10482 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10483
10484 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10485 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10486 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10487 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10488 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10489 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10490 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10491 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10492 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10493 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10494 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10495 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10496
10497 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10498 should not use this directive.
10499
10500 The default is "conn-failure".
10501
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010502 Example:
10503 retry-on 503 504
10504
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010505 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10506
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010507server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010508 Declare a server in a backend
10509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10510 no | no | yes | yes
10511 Arguments :
10512 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010514 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010515
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010516 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10517 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10518 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10519 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010520 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10521 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010522 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010523 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10524 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010525 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10526 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10527 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10528 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10529 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10530 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10531 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010532 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010533 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10534 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10535 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10536 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10537 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10538 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010539 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10540 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010541 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10542 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010543
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010544 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010545 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10546 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10547 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10548 adding this value to the client's port.
10549
10550 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10551 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010552 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010553
10554 Examples :
10555 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10556 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010557 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010558 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10559 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10560 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010562 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10563 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10564 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10565 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10566 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10567
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010568 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10569 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010570
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010571server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010572 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010573 this backend.
10574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10575 no | no | yes | yes
10576
10577 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10578 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10579 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10580 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10581 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010582
10583 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10584 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10585
10586 global
10587 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10588
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010589 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010590 load-server-state-from-file
10591
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010592 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010593 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010594
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010595server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10596 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10597 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10599 no | no | yes | yes
10600
10601 Arguments:
10602 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10603
10604 <num | range>
10605 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10606 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10607 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10608 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10609
10610 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10611
10612 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10613
10614 <params*>
10615 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10616 keyword.
10617
10618 Examples:
10619 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10620 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10621 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10622
10623 # or
10624 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10625
10626 # would be equivalent to:
10627 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10628 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10629 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10630
10631
10632
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010633source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010634source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010635source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010636 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10638 yes | no | yes | yes
10639 Arguments :
10640 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10641 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010642
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010643 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010644 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10645 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10646 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10647 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10648 supported prefixes are :
10649 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10650 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10651 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010652 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010653 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10654 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010655
10656 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10657 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010658 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10659 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10660 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010661
10662 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10663 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10664 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10665 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10666 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10667 <addr>.
10668
10669 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10670 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10671 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10672 port.
10673
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010674 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10675 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10676 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10677 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010678 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010679 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10680 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10681 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10682 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10683 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10684 HTTP header.
10685
10686 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10687 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010688 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010689 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10690 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10691 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10692 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10693 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10694 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10695 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10696
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010697 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10698 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10699 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10700 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10701 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10702 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10703
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010704 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10705 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10706 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10707 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10708
10709 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10710 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10711 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10712 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10713 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10714 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10715
10716 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10717 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10718 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10719 there are two methods :
10720
10721 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10722 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10723 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10724 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10725 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10726 of the client ranges may be used.
10727
10728 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10729 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10730 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10731 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10732 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10733 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10734 same session.
10735
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010736 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10737 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10738 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010739 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010741 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10742
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010743 Examples :
10744 backend private
10745 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10746 source 192.168.1.200
10747
10748 backend transparent_ssl1
10749 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10750 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10751
10752 backend transparent_ssl2
10753 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10754 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10755 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10756
10757 backend transparent_ssl3
10758 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10759 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10760 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10761
10762 backend transparent_smtp
10763 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10764 # with Tproxy version 4.
10765 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10766
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010767 backend transparent_http
10768 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10769 # proxy.
10770 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010772 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010773 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10774
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010775
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010776srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10777 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10778 the connection on the server side.
10779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10780 yes | no | yes | yes
10781 Arguments :
10782 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10783
10784 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10785 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010786 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10787 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010788
10789 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10790
10791
10792srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10793 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10794 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10795 server side.
10796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10797 yes | no | yes | yes
10798 Arguments :
10799 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10800 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10801 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10802 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10803
10804 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10805 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010806 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10807 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010808
10809 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10810
10811
10812srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10813 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10815 yes | no | yes | yes
10816 Arguments :
10817 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10818 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10819 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10820 document.
10821
10822 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10823 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010824 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10825 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010826
10827 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10828
10829
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010830stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10831 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010833 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010834
10835 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10836 matched.
10837
10838 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10839 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10840
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010841 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10842 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10843 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10844 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010845
10846 Example :
10847 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10848 backend stats_localhost
10849 stats enable
10850 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10851
10852 Example :
10853 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10854 backend stats_auth
10855 stats enable
10856 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10857 stats admin if TRUE
10858
10859 Example :
10860 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10861 userlist stats-auth
10862 group admin users admin
10863 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10864 group readonly users haproxy
10865 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10866
10867 backend stats_auth
10868 stats enable
10869 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10870 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10871 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10872 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10873
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010874 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10875 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010876
10877
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010878stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10879 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010881 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010882 Arguments :
10883 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10884
10885 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10886
10887 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10888 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10889 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10890 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10891 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10892 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10893
10894 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10895 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10896 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010897 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010898
10899 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10900 report using "stats scope".
10901
10902 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10903 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10904 unobvious parameters.
10905
10906 Example :
10907 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10908 backend public_www
10909 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10910 stats enable
10911 stats hide-version
10912 stats scope .
10913 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010914 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010915 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10916 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10917
10918 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10919 backend private_monitoring
10920 stats enable
10921 stats uri /admin?stats
10922 stats refresh 5s
10923
10924 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10925
10926
10927stats enable
10928 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010930 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010931 Arguments : none
10932
10933 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10934 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10935 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10936 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10937 - stats auth : no authentication
10938 - stats scope : no restriction
10939
10940 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10941 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10942 unobvious parameters.
10943
10944 Example :
10945 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10946 backend public_www
10947 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10948 stats enable
10949 stats hide-version
10950 stats scope .
10951 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010953 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10954 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10955
10956 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10957 backend private_monitoring
10958 stats enable
10959 stats uri /admin?stats
10960 stats refresh 5s
10961
10962 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10963
10964
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010965stats hide-version
10966 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010968 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010969 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010970
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010971 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10972 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10973 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10974 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10975 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10976 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010978 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10979 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10980 unobvious parameters.
10981
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010982 Example :
10983 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10984 backend public_www
10985 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010986 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010987 stats hide-version
10988 stats scope .
10989 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010991 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10992 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010993
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010994 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10995 backend private_monitoring
10996 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010997 stats uri /admin?stats
10998 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010999
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011000 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011001
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011002
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011003stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11004 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11005 Access control for statistics
11006
11007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11008 no | no | yes | yes
11009
11010 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11011 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11012 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11013 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11014 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11015 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11016
11017 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11018 instance.
11019
11020 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11021 about ACL usage.
11022
11023
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011024stats realm <realm>
11025 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011027 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011028 Arguments :
11029 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11030 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11031 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11032
11033 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11034 using a backslash ('\').
11035
11036 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11037 only related to authentication.
11038
11039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11041 unobvious parameters.
11042
11043 Example :
11044 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11045 backend public_www
11046 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11047 stats enable
11048 stats hide-version
11049 stats scope .
11050 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011051 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011052 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11053 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11054
11055 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11056 backend private_monitoring
11057 stats enable
11058 stats uri /admin?stats
11059 stats refresh 5s
11060
11061 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11062
11063
11064stats refresh <delay>
11065 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011068 Arguments :
11069 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11070 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11071 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11072 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11073 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11074 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11075
11076 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11077 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11078 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011079 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011080
11081 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11082 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11083 unobvious parameters.
11084
11085 Example :
11086 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11087 backend public_www
11088 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11089 stats enable
11090 stats hide-version
11091 stats scope .
11092 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011093 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011094 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11095 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11096
11097 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11098 backend private_monitoring
11099 stats enable
11100 stats uri /admin?stats
11101 stats refresh 5s
11102
11103 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11104
11105
11106stats scope { <name> | "." }
11107 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011109 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011110 Arguments :
11111 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11112 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11113 section in which the statement appears.
11114
11115 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11116 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11117 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11118 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11119 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11120 exists.
11121
11122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11124 unobvious parameters.
11125
11126 Example :
11127 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11128 backend public_www
11129 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11130 stats enable
11131 stats hide-version
11132 stats scope .
11133 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011134 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011135 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11136 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11137
11138 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11139 backend private_monitoring
11140 stats enable
11141 stats uri /admin?stats
11142 stats refresh 5s
11143
11144 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11145
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011146
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011147stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011148 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011151
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011152 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011153 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11154
11155 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11156 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11157
11158 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11159 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011160 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011161
11162 Example :
11163 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11164 backend private_monitoring
11165 stats enable
11166 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11167 stats uri /admin?stats
11168 stats refresh 5s
11169
11170 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11171 global section.
11172
11173
11174stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011175 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11177 yes | yes | yes | yes
11178 Arguments : none
11179
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011180 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011181 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11182 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11183 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11184 - IP (socket, server)
11185 - cookie (backend, server)
11186
11187 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11188 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011189 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011190
11191 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11192
11193
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011194stats show-modules
11195 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11197 yes | yes | yes | yes
11198 Arguments : none
11199
11200 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11201 values as a tooltip.
11202
11203 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11204 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11205 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11206
11207 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11208
11209
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011210stats show-node [ <name> ]
11211 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011213 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011214 Arguments:
11215 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11216 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11217
11218 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11219 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011221
11222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11224 unobvious parameters.
11225
11226 Example:
11227 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11228 backend private_monitoring
11229 stats enable
11230 stats show-node Europe-1
11231 stats uri /admin?stats
11232 stats refresh 5s
11233
11234 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11235 section.
11236
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011237
11238stats uri <prefix>
11239 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011241 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011242 Arguments :
11243 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11244 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11245 query string.
11246
11247 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11248 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11249 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11250 possible to reach it in the application.
11251
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011252 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011253 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011254 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11255 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11256 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11257 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11258
11259 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11260 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11261 an address or a port to statistics only.
11262
11263 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11264 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11265 unobvious parameters.
11266
11267 Example :
11268 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11269 backend public_www
11270 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11271 stats enable
11272 stats hide-version
11273 stats scope .
11274 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011275 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011276 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11277 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11278
11279 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11280 backend private_monitoring
11281 stats enable
11282 stats uri /admin?stats
11283 stats refresh 5s
11284
11285 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11286
11287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011288stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11289 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011291 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011292
11293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011294 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011295 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011296 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011297 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11298
11299 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11300 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11301 the "stick-table" statement.
11302
11303 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11304 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11305 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11306 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11307 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11308
11309 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11310 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11311 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11312 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11313 transformation rules.
11314
11315 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11316 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11317 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11318 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11319 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11320 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11321 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11322
11323 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11324 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11325 ACL based conditions.
11326
11327 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11328 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11329 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11330 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11331
11332 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11333 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11334 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11335 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11336
11337 Example :
11338 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11339 # last 30 minutes
11340 backend pop
11341 mode tcp
11342 balance roundrobin
11343 stick store-request src
11344 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11345 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11346 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11347
11348 backend smtp
11349 mode tcp
11350 balance roundrobin
11351 stick match src table pop
11352 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11353 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11354
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011355 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11356 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011357
11358
11359stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11360 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11362 no | no | yes | yes
11363
11364 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11365 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11366 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11367 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11368
11369 Examples :
11370 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011371 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011372
11373 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11374 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11375 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11376
11377
11378 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11379 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11380 backend http
11381 mode http
11382 balance roundrobin
11383 stick on src table https
11384 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11385 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11386 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11387
11388 backend https
11389 mode tcp
11390 balance roundrobin
11391 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11392 stick on src
11393 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11394 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11395
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011396 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011397
11398
11399stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11400 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11402 no | no | yes | yes
11403
11404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011405 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011406 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011407 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011408 server is selected.
11409
11410 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11411 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11412 the "stick-table" statement.
11413
11414 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11415 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11416 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11417 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11418 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11419 address.
11420
11421 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11422 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11423 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11424 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11425 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11426 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11427 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11428 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11429 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11430 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11431
11432 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11433 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11434 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11435 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11436 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11437 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11438 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11439
11440 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11441 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11442 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11443 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11444
11445 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11446 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11447 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11448 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11449 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11450 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011451 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11452 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11453 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11454 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11455 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11456 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011457
11458 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11459 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11460 the request.
11461
11462 Example :
11463 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11464 # last 30 minutes
11465 backend pop
11466 mode tcp
11467 balance roundrobin
11468 stick store-request src
11469 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11470 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11471 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11472
11473 backend smtp
11474 mode tcp
11475 balance roundrobin
11476 stick match src table pop
11477 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11478 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11479
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011480 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011481
11482
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011483stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011484 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011485 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011486 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011488 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011489
11490 Arguments :
11491 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11492 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11493 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11494 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11495
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011496 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11497 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11498 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11499 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11500
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011501 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11502 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11503 instance.
11504
11505 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11506 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11507 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11508 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11509 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11510 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011511 to 32 characters.
11512
11513 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11514 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11515 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011516 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011517 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11518 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011519
11520 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011521 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11522 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011523 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11524 increase.
11525
11526 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011527 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11528 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11529 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011530
11531 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011532 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011533 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11534 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011535 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011536 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11537 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11538 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11539 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11540 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11541 parameter (see below).
11542
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011543 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11544 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11545 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11546 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11547 soft restart.
11548
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011549 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11550 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11551 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11552 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011553 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011554 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011555 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11556 if not expiration delay is specified.
11557
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011558 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11559 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11560 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11561 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11562 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11563 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11564 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11565 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11566 token.
11567
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011568 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11569 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11570 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11571 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011572 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11573 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11574 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11575 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11576 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11577 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11578 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11579 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11580 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11581 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11582 types and their arguments.
11583
11584 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11585 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11586 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11587 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11588
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011589 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11590 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11591 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11592 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11593 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11594 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11595 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11596 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11597 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11598 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011599 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11600 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11601 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11602 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011603
11604 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11605 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11606 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11607 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11608 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11609 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11610 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11611 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11612 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11613 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11614 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11615 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011616 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11617 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11618 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11619 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011620
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011621 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11622 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11623 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011624 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011625
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011626 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11627 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11628 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011629 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011630 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011631 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011632
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011633 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11634 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11635 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11636 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11637
11638 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11639 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11640 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11641 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11642 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11643 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11644
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011645 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11646 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11647 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11648 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11649 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11650 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11651 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11652 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11653 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11654 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011655 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11656 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11657 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011658
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011659 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11660 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11661 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11662 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11663
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011664 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11665 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11666 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11667 they were received.
11668
11669 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11670 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11671 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11672 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11673 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11674
11675 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11676 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11677 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11678 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11679 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11680
11681 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11682 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11683 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11684
11685 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11686 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11687 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11688 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11689 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11690
11691 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11692 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11693 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11694 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11695 the client side.
11696
11697 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11698 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11699 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11700 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11701 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11702 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11703 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11704
11705 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11706 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11707 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11708 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11709 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11710 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011711 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011712
11713 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11714 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11715 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11716 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11717 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11718 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11719
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011720 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11721 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11722 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11723 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11724 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11725
11726 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11727 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11728 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11729 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11730 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11731 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11732
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011733 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011734 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011735 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11736 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11737
11738 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11739 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11740 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11741 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11742 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11743 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11744 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11745 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11746 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11747 recommended for better fairness.
11748
11749 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011750 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011751 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11752 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11753
11754 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11755 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11756 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11757 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11758 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11759 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11760 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11761 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11762 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11763 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011764
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011765 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11766 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011767 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11768 reference it.
11769
11770 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11771 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011772 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11773 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11774 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011775
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011776 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11777 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11778 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11779 something that can be ignored.
11780
11781 Example:
11782 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11783 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11784 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11785 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11786
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011787 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011788 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011789
11790
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011791stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011792 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11794 no | no | yes | yes
11795
11796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011797 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011798 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011799 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011800 server is selected.
11801
11802 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11803 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11804 the "stick-table" statement.
11805
11806 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11807 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11808 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11809 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11810
11811 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11812 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11813 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11814 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11815 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11816 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011817 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011818 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11819 rules.
11820
11821 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11822 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11823 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11824 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11825 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11826 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11827 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11828
11829 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11830 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11831 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11832 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11833
11834 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11835 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11836 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11837 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11838 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11839 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011840 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11841 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11842 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11843 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11844 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11845 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11846 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11847 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11848 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011849
11850 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11851
11852 Example :
11853 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11854 backend https
11855 mode tcp
11856 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011857 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011858 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011859
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011860 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11861 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011862
11863 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11864 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11865 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11866
11867 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11868 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011869
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011870 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11871 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11872 # at offset 44.
11873
11874 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011875 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011876
11877 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011878 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011879
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011880 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11881 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11882
11883 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11884 extraction.
11885
11886
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011887tcp-check comment <string>
11888 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11889 it fails.
11890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11891 yes | no | yes | yes
11892
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011893 Arguments :
11894 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11895 rule fails.
11896
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011897 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11898 user-friendly error reporting.
11899
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011900 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11901 "tcp-check expect".
11902
11903
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011904tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11905 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011906 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011907 Opens a new connection
11908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011909 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011911 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011912 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11913
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011914 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011915 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011916
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011917 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011918 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11919 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011920 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011921
11922 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011923
11924 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11925
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011926 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11927
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11929
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011930 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11931
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011932 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11933 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11934 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11935 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11936
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011937 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11938 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11939 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11940 haproxy -vv.
11941
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011942 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011943
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011944 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11945 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11946 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11947
11948 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11949 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11950 of the sequence.
11951
11952 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11953 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11954 do.
11955
11956 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11957 unset-var or comment rules.
11958
11959 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011960 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11961 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11962 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11963 option tcp-check
11964 tcp-check connect
11965 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11966 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11967 tcp-check send \r\n
11968 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11969 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11970 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11971 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11972 tcp-check send \r\n
11973 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11974 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11975
11976 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11977 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011978 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011979 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11980 tcp-check connect port 143
11981 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11982 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11983
11984 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11985
11986
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011987tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011988 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011989 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011990 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011991 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011993 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011994
11995 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011996 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11997
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011998 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11999 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12000 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12001 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12002 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12003 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12004 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12005 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12006 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12007 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12008
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012009 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012010 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12011 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012012 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12013 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12014 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12015
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012016 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12017 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12018 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012019 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12020 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012021 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12022 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012023 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12024 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012025 By default "L7OK" is used.
12026
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012027 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12028 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012029 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12030 supported :
12031 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12032 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012033 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12034 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12035 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12036 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12037 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012038
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012039 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012040 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012041 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12042 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12043 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12044 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012045 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12046
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012047 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12048 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12049 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12050 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12051
12052 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12053 informational message reported in logs if an error
12054 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12055 log-format string.
12056
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012057 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12058 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12059 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12060 followed by some converters.
12061
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012062 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12063 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12064 with the usual backslash ('\').
12065 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012066 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012067 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12068 used upper or lower case.
12069
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012070 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12071
12072 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12073 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12074 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12075 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12076 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12077 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12078 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12079 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12080
12081 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12082 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12083 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12084 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12085 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12086 expression.
12087
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012088 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12089 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12090 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12091 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12092 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12093 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12094
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012095 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12096 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12097 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12098 this exact hexadecimal string.
12099 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12100
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012101 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12102 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12103 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12104 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12105 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12106 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12107 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12108 size.
12109
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012110 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12111 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12112 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12113 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12114 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12115 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12116 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12117 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12118 in a binary string before matching the response's
12119 buffer.
12120
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012121 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012122 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012123 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12124 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12125 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12126 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12127 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12128 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12129 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12130 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12131 the null character.
12132
12133 Examples :
12134 # perform a POP check
12135 option tcp-check
12136 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12137
12138 # perform an IMAP check
12139 option tcp-check
12140 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12141
12142 # look for the redis master server
12143 option tcp-check
12144 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012145 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012146 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12147 tcp-check expect string role:master
12148 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12149 tcp-check expect string +OK
12150
12151
12152 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012153 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012154
12155
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012156tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12157tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12158 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12159 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012161 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012162
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012163 Arguments :
12164 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12165
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012166 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12167 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012168
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012169 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12170 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012171
12172 Examples :
12173 # look for the redis master server
12174 option tcp-check
12175 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12176 tcp-check expect string role:master
12177
12178 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012179 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012180
12181
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012182tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12183tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12184 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12185 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012187 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012188
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012189 Arguments :
12190 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012191
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012192 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12193 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012194
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012195 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12196 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12197 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012198
12199 Examples :
12200 # redis check in binary
12201 option tcp-check
12202 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12203 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12204
12205
12206 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012207 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012208
12209
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012210tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12211tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012212 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012214 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012215
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012216 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012217 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12218 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12219 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12220 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12221 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12223 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12224 and '-'.
12225
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012226 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12227 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012228 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012229 conditions.
12230
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012231 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12232
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012233 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12234 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12235
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012236 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012237 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012238 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012239
12240
12241tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012242 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012244 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012245
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012246 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012247 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12248 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12251 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12253 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12254 and '-'.
12255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012256 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012257 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12258
12259
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012260tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012261 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012263 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012264 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012265 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12266 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012267
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012268 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012269
12270 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12271 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012272 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12273 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12274 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12275 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12276 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12277 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12280 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12281 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012282 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12283 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12284 is true.
12285
12286 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12287 supported:
12288 - accept
12289 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12290 - expect-proxy layer4
12291 - reject
12292 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12293 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12294 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12295 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12296 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12297 - set-dst <expr>
12298 - set-dst-port <expr>
12299 - set-mark <mark>
12300 - set-src <expr>
12301 - set-src-port <expr>
12302 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012303 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12304 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012305 - silent-drop
12306 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12307 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12308 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012309 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012310
12311 The supported actions are described below.
12312
12313 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12314 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012315
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012316 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12317 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12318 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12319 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12320 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12321 a defaults section defining such rules.
12322
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012323 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12324 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12325 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012326
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012327 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12328 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12329 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012330
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012331 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12332 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12333 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012334
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012335 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12336 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12337 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012338
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012339 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12340 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12341 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012342
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012343 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012344
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012345 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012346
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012347 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012348
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012349 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012351tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012352
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012353 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12354 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012355
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012356tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012358
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012359 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12360 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12361 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12362 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12363 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12364 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12365 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012366
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012367tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012368
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012369 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12370 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12371 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12372 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12373 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12374 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012375
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012376tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012377
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012378 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12379 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12380 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12381 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12382 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12383 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12384 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12385 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12386 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12387 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12388 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012389
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012390tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12391tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12392tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012393
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012394 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12395 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12396 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12397 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012399tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12401tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12402 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012403
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012404 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12405 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12406 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012407
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012408tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12409tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012410
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012411 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12412 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12413 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012414
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012415tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012417 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12418 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12419 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012420
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012421tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12422tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012423
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012424 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12425 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12426 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012427
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012428tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012429
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012430 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12431 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12432 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012433
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012434tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12435tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012436
12437 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12438 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12439 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12440 for a complete description.
12441
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012442tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012443
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12445 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12446 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12447 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012448
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012449tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12450tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12451tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012452
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012453 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12454 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12455 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012456
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012457tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12458
12459 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12460 details about variables.
12461
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012463tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12464 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012466 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012468 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12469 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012471 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012472
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012473 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012474 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12475 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012476 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12477 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012479 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12480 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12481 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12482 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012483 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012484 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012485 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12486 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12487 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12488 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012489 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012490 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012492 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12493 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12494 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12495 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012496
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012497 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12498 supported:
12499 - accept
12500 - capture <sample> len <length>
12501 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12502 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012503 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012504 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012505 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012506 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012507 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012508 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012509 - set-dst <expr>
12510 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012511 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012512 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012513 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012514 - set-priority-class <expr>
12515 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012516 - set-src <expr>
12517 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012518 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012519 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12520 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012521 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012522 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012523 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12524 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12525 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012526 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012527 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012528
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012529 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012530
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012531 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12532 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12533 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12534 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12535 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12536 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012537
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012538 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12539 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12540 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12541 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12542 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12543 a defaults section defining such rules.
12544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012545 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012546 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12547 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012548
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012549 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12550 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12551 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12552 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12553 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12554 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12555
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012556 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012557 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12558 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12559 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12560 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12561 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12562 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12563 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12564 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12565 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12566 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012567
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012568 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012569 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12570 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12571 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012572
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012573 Example:
12574 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12575
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012576 Example:
12577
12578 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012579 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012580 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012581
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012582 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012583 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012584 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012585 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12586 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012587 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012588 tcp-request content reject
12589
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012590 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12591 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12592 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12593 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12594 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12595 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12596 ...
12597 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012599 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012600 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12601 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012602 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012603 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012604
12605 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12606 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012607 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012608 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012609 tcp-request content reject
12610
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012611 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012612 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012613 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012614 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012615 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12616 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012617
12618 Example:
12619 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12620 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012621 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012623 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012624 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012625
12626 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012627 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012628 # protecting all our sites
12629 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012630 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12631 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012632 ...
12633 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12634
12635 backend http_dynamic
12636 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012637 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012638 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012639 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012640 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012641 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012642 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012645
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012646 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12647 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012648
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012649tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12650
12651 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012652 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012653
12654tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12655 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12656
12657 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12658 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12659 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12660 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12661 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12662 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12663 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12664 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12665 information.
12666
12667tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12668
12669 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12670 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12671 complete description.
12672
12673tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12674
12675 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12676 are evaluated.
12677
12678tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12679tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12680tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12681
12682 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12683 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12684 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12685 description.
12686
12687tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12688 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12689tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12690 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12691
12692 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12693 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12694 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12695
12696tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12697 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12698
12699 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12700 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12701
12702tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12703tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12704
12705 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12706 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12707 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12708
12709tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12710
12711 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12712 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12713
12714tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12715
12716 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12717 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12718 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12719
12720tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12721
12722 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12723 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12724
12725tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12726
12727 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12728 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12729
12730tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12731
12732 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12733 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12734 description.
12735
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012736tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12737tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12738
12739 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12740 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12741 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12742
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012743tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12744
12745 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12746 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12747 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12748
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012749tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12750tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012751
12752 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12753 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12754 for a complete description.
12755
12756tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12757
12758 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12759 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12760 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12761 complete description.
12762
12763tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12764 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12765
12766 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12767 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12768 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12769 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12770 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12771 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12772 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12773 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12774 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12775 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12776
12777 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12778
12779tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12780tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12781tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12782
12783 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12784 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12785 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12786
12787tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12788
12789 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12790 details about variables.
12791
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020012792tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012793
12794 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12795 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12796 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12797 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12798 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12799
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012800
12801tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12802 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012804 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012805 Arguments :
12806 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12808 as explained at the top of this document.
12809
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012810 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012811 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12812 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12813 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12814 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12815
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012816 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12817 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12818 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12819 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12820
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012821 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012822 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012823 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012824 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012825 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012826 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12827 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12828 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012829
12830 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12831 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12832 it pass through unaffected.
12833
12834 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12835 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12836 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012837 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012838 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12839 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012840 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12841 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12842 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012843
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012844 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12845 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12846
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012847 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012848 "timeout client".
12849
12850
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012851tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12852 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012854 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012855 Arguments :
12856 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12857 below.
12858
12859 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12860
12861 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12862 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12863 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12864 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012865 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012866 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12867 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12868 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12869 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12870 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12871 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12872 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12873 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12874 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12875 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12876 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12877 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12878 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12879 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12880 instead.
12881
12882 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12883 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12884 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12885 rules which may be inserted.
12886
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012887 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12888 supported:
12889 - accept
12890 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012891 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12892 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12893 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12894 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12895 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012896 - set-dst <expr>
12897 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012898 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012899 - set-src <expr>
12900 - set-src-port <expr>
12901 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012902 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12903 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012904 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012905 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12906 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12907 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12908 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012909
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012910 The supported actions are described below.
12911
12912 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12913 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12914 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12915 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12916 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12917 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012918
12919 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12920 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12921 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12922
12923 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12924 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12925 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12926 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12927 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12928
12929 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12930 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12931
12932 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12933 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12934 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12935
12936 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12937 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12938 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12939
12940 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12941 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12942 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12943
12944 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12945 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12946 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12947
12948 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12949
12950 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12951
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012952tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12953
12954 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12955 rules are evaluated.
12956
12957tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12958
12959 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12960 are evaluated.
12961
12962tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12963tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12964tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12965
12966 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12967 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12968 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12969 description.
12970
12971tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12972 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12973tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12974 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12975
12976 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12977 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12978 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12979 description.
12980
12981tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12982tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12983
12984 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12985 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12986 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12987
12988tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12989
12990 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12991 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12992 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12993
12994tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12995tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12996
12997 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12998 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12999 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13000
13001tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13002
13003 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13004 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13005 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13006
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013007tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13008tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013009
13010 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13011 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13012 for a complete description.
13013
13014tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13015
13016 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13017 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13018 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13019 complete description.
13020
13021tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13022tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13023tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13024
13025 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13026 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13027 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13028
13029tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13030
13031 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13032 details about variables.
13033
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013034
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013035tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13036 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013038 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013040 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13041 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013042
13043 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13044
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013045 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013046 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13047 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013048 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13049 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013050
13051 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13052
13053 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13054 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13055 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13056 inserted.
13057
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013058 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13059 supported:
13060 - accept
13061 - close
13062 - reject
13063 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13064 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13065 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13066 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13067 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13068 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13069 - set-log-level <level>
13070 - set-mark <mark>
13071 - set-nice <nice>
13072 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013073 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13074 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013075 - silent-drop
13076 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13077
13078 The supported actions are described below.
13079
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013080 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13081 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13082 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13083 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13084 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13085 a defaults section defining such rules.
13086
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013087 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13088 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13089 for changing the default action to a reject.
13090
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013091 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013092
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013093 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13094 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13095 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13096 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13097 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013098
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013099 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013100
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013101 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013102
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013103tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013104
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013105 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13106 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013107
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013108tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013109
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013110 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13111 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13112 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13113 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13114 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13115 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013116
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013117tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013118
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013119 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13120 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013121
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013122tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13123tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13124tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013125
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013126 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13127 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13128 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13129 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013130
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013131tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13133tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13134 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013135
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013136 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13137 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13138 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013139
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013140tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13141 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013142
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013143 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13144 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013145
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013146tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013147
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013148 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13149 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013150
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013151tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013152
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013153 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13154 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13155 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013156
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013157tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013158
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013159 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13160 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013161
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013162tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013163
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013164 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13165 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13166 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013167
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013168tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13169tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013170
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013171 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13172 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13173 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013174
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013175tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013176
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013177 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13178 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13179 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13180 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013181
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013182tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013183
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013184 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13185 details about variables.
13186
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013187
13188tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13189 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013191 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013192 Arguments :
13193 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13194 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13195 as explained at the top of this document.
13196
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013197 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13198 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013199
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013200 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13201
13202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013203timeout check <timeout>
13204 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13205 established.
13206
13207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13208 yes | no | yes | yes
13209 Arguments:
13210 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13212 as explained at the top of this document.
13213
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013214 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013215 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013216 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013217 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013218 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13219 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13220 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013221
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013222 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013223 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13224
13225 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13226 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013227 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013228
13229 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13230 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13231 forget about it.
13232
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013233 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13234 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13235
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013236 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13237 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013238
13239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013240timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013241 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13243 yes | yes | yes | no
13244 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013245 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013246 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13247 as explained at the top of this document.
13248
13249 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13250 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13251 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013252 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13253 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13254 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13255 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013256 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13257 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13258 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013259 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013260 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013261 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13262 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013263 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13264 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013265
13266 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13267 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13268 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13269 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013270 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013271 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13272
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013273 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013275
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013276timeout client-fin <timeout>
13277 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13279 yes | yes | yes | no
13280 Arguments :
13281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13283 as explained at the top of this document.
13284
13285 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13286 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13287 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13288 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13289 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13290 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13291 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013292 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13293 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13294 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013295
13296 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13297 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13298 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13299
13300 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13301
13302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013303timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013304 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13306 yes | no | yes | yes
13307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013308 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013309 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13310 as explained at the top of this document.
13311
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013312 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013313 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013314 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013315 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013316 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13317 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013318
13319 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13320 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13321 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13322 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013323 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013324 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13325
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013326 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013328
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013329timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13330 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13332 yes | yes | yes | yes
13333 Arguments :
13334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13336 as explained at the top of this document.
13337
13338 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13339 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13340 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13341 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13342 once the request has started to present itself.
13343
13344 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13345 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13346 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13347 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13348 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13349
13350 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13351 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13352 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13353 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13354
13355 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13356 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013357 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013358 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13359 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013360 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013361
13362 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13363 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13364 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13365 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13366
13367 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13368
13369
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013370timeout http-request <timeout>
13371 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013373 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013374 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013375 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013376 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13377 as explained at the top of this document.
13378
13379 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13380 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13381 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13382 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13383 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13384 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13385 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013386 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13387 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13388 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13389 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013390 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013391 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13392 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013393
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013394 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13395 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13396 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13397 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13398 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013399 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013400
13401 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13402 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013404 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13405 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13406
13407 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013408 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13409 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13410 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013411
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013412 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013413 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013414
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013415
13416timeout queue <timeout>
13417 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13419 yes | no | yes | yes
13420 Arguments :
13421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13423 as explained at the top of this document.
13424
13425 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13426 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13427 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13428 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13429 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13430
13431 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13432 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13433 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13434 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13435
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013436 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013437
13438
13439timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013440 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13442 yes | no | yes | yes
13443 Arguments :
13444 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13445 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13446 as explained at the top of this document.
13447
13448 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13449 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13450 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13451 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13452 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13453 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13454 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13455
13456 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13457 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13458 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13459 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13460 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013461 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013462 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013463 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13464 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013465 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13466 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013467
13468 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13469 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13470 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13471 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013472 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013473 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13474
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013475 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013476
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013477
13478timeout server-fin <timeout>
13479 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13481 yes | no | yes | yes
13482 Arguments :
13483 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13484 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13485 as explained at the top of this document.
13486
13487 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13488 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13489 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13490 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13491 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13492 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13493 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13494 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13495 situations, it should not be needed.
13496
13497 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13498 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13499 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13500
13501 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13502
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013503
13504timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013505 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13507 yes | yes | yes | yes
13508 Arguments :
13509 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13511 as explained at the top of this document.
13512
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013513 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13514 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13515 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013516
13517 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13518 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13519 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13520 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013521 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013522
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013523 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013524
13525
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013526timeout tunnel <timeout>
13527 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13529 yes | no | yes | yes
13530 Arguments :
13531 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13532 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13533 as explained at the top of this document.
13534
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013535 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013536 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13537 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13538 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13540 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013541 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13542 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13543 specified.
13544
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013545 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13546 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13547 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13548 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13549 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13550 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13551 state.
13552
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013553 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13554 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13555 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13556 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013557 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013558
13559 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13560 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13561 forget about it.
13562
13563 Example :
13564 defaults http
13565 option http-server-close
13566 timeout connect 5s
13567 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013568 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013569 timeout server 30s
13570 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13571
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013572 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013573
13574
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013575transparent (deprecated)
13576 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013578 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013579 Arguments : none
13580
13581 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13582 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13583 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13584 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13585 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13586 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13587 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13588 appropriate server.
13589
13590 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13591
13592 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13593 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13594
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013595 See also: "option transparent"
13596
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013597unique-id-format <string>
13598 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13600 yes | yes | yes | no
13601 Arguments :
13602 <string> is a log-format string.
13603
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013604 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13605 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13606 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13607 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013608
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013609 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013610 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013611 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13612 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13613 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13614 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13615 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13616 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013617
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013618 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13619 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013620
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013621 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013622
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013623 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013624
13625 will generate:
13626
13627 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13628
13629 See also: "unique-id-header"
13630
13631unique-id-header <name>
13632 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13634 yes | yes | yes | no
13635 Arguments :
13636 <name> is the name of the header.
13637
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013638 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13639 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013640
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013641 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013642
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013643 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013644 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13645
13646 will generate:
13647
13648 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13649
13650 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013651
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013652use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013653 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13655 no | yes | yes | no
13656 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013657 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13658 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013659
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013660 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13661 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013662
13663 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13664 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13665 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013666 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013667 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013668 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13669 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013670
13671 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13672 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13673 assign the backend.
13674
13675 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13676 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13677 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13678 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13679 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13680 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13681
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013682 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013683 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013684 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13685 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13686 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13687
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013688 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13689 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13690 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13691 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13692 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13693 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13694 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13695 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13696 cannot be forced from the request.
13697
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013698 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013699 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13700 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13701
13702 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13703 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013704
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013705use-fcgi-app <name>
13706 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13708 no | no | yes | yes
13709 Arguments :
13710 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13711
13712 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013713
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013714use-server <server> if <condition>
13715use-server <server> unless <condition>
13716 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13718 no | no | yes | yes
13719 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013720 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13721 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013722
13723 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13724
13725 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13726 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13727 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13728
13729 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13730 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13731 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13732 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13733 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13734 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13735 matches will assign the server.
13736
13737 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13738 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13739 with the next rules until one matches.
13740
13741 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13742 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13743 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13744 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13745
13746 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13747 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13748 stripped.
13749
13750 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13751 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013752 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013753 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013754 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013755
13756 Example :
13757 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013758 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013759 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013760 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013761 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013762 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013763 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013764 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13765 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13766
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013767 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13768 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13769 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13770 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013771 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013772 and we fall back to load balancing.
13773
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013774 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100137775. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013778--------------------------
13779
13780The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13781depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13782settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13783written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13784described in this section.
13785
13786
137875.1. Bind options
13788-----------------
13789
13790The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13791as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13792no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13793parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13794while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13795provided immediately after the setting name.
13796
13797The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13798
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013799accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13800 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13801 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13802 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13803 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13804 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13805 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13806 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13807 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13808 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013809 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13810 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13811 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013812
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013813accept-proxy
13814 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013815 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13816 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013817 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13818 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13819 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13820 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013821 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013822 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13823 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013824 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13825 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013826
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013827allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013828 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013829 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013830 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013831 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13832 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013833
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013834alpn <protocols>
13835 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13836 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13837 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013838 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013839 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013840 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13841 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13842 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13843 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13844 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13845 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13846 preference, like below :
13847
13848 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013850backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013851 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013852 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13853
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013854curves <curves>
13855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13856 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13857 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13858 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13859 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13860 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13861
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013862ecdhe <named curve>
13863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013864 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13865 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013866
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013867ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13869 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020013870 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
13871 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020013872 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013873
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013874ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13876 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13877 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13878 error is ignored.
13879
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013880ca-sign-file <cafile>
13881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13882 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13883 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13884 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13885 'generate-certificates' for details.
13886
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013887ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13889 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13890 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13891 'generate-certificates' for details.
13892
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013893ca-verify-file <cafile>
13894 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13895 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13896 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13897 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13898 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013900ciphers <ciphers>
13901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13902 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013903 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013904 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013905 information and recommendations see e.g.
13906 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13907 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13908 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13909
13910ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13912 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13913 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13914 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013915 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13916 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013917
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013918crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13920 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013921 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13922 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013923
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013924crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13926 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13927 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13928 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13929 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013930 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13931 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013932
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013933 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13934 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13935
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013936 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13937 are loaded.
13938
13939 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013940 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020013941 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
13942 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
13943 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
13944 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
13945 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
13946 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
13947 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
13948 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013949
13950 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13951 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13952 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13953 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013954 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13955 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013956
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013957 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013958
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013959 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013960 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013961 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13962 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013963 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13964 clients).
13965
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013966 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013967 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13968 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13969 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13970 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13971 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13972 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13973 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13974 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13975 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13976 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13977 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13978 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13979
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013980 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013981 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13982 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13983 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13984 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13985
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013986 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13987 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13988 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13989 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013990
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013991 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13992 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13993 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013994
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013995crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013997 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013998 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013999 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014000
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014001crt-list <file>
14002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014003 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14004 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014005
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014006 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14007
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014008 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14009 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14010 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14011 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14012 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014013
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014014 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014015 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14016 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14017 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14018 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14019 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014020 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14021 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14022 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014023
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014024 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14025 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14026 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014027
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014028 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14029
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014030 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014031 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014032 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14033 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14034 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14035 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14036 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14037 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014038
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014039 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014040 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014041 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014042 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014043 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014044 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014046defer-accept
14047 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14048 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14049 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014050 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014051 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14052 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14053 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14054 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14055 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14056 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14057 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14058
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014059expose-fd listeners
14060 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14061 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014062 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14063 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014065
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014066force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014067 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014068 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014069 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014070 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014071
14072force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014074 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014075 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014076
14077force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014078 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014079 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014080 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014081
14082force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014083 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014084 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014085 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014086
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014087force-tlsv13
14088 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14089 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014090 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014091
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014092generate-certificates
14093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14094 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14095 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14096 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14097 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14098 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14099 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14100 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14101 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14102 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14103 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14104
14105 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14106 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014107 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014108 certificate is used many times.
14109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014110gid <gid>
14111 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14112 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14113 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14114 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14115 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14116
14117group <group>
14118 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14119 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14120 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14121 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14122 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14123
14124id <id>
14125 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14126 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14127 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14128 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14129
14130interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014131 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14132 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14133 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14134 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14135 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14136 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014137 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14138 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14139 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14140 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14141 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14142 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014143
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014144level <level>
14145 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14146 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14147 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014148 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014149 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14150 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14151 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014152 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014153 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014154 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014155 all counters).
14156
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014157severity-output <format>
14158 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14159 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14160 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14161 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14162 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14163 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14164 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14165 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14166 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14167 rfc5424 convention.
14168
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014169maxconn <maxconn>
14170 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14171 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14172 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14173 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14174 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14175 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14176 eat all memory.
14177
14178mode <mode>
14179 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14180 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14181 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14182 UNIX sockets.
14183
14184mss <maxseg>
14185 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14186 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14187 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14188 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14189 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14190 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14191 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14192 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14193 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14194 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14195 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14196
14197name <name>
14198 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14199 page.
14200
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014201namespace <name>
14202 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14203 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14204 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14205 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14206
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014207nice <nice>
14208 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14209 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14210 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14211 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14212 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14213 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14214 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14215 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14216 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14217 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14218 one for an RDP socket.
14219
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014220no-ca-names
14221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14222 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014223 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014224
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014225no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014227 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014228 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014229 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014230 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14231 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014232
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014233no-tls-tickets
14234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14235 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14236 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014237 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14238 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014239 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14240 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14241 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014242
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014243no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014245 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014246 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014247 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014248 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14249 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014250
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014251no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014253 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014254 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014255 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014256 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14257 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014258
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014259no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014261 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014262 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014263 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014264 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14265 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014266
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014267no-tlsv13
14268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14269 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14270 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14271 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014272 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14273 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014274
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014275npn <protocols>
14276 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14277 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14278 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014279 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014280 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014281 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14282 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14283 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14284 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14285 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014286
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014287prefer-client-ciphers
14288 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14289 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14290 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014291 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14292 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14293 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014294
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014295process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014296 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14297 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14298 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14299 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14300 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14301 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014302
14303 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14304
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014305 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014306 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14307 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14308 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14309 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14310 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014311
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014312 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14313 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14314
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014315proto <name>
14316 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14317 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14318 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014319 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14320 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14321
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014322 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14323 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14324 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014325
14326 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14327 a bind line :
14328
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014329 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014330 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14331 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14332
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014333 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014334 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014335 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014336 h2" on the bind line.
14337
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014338shards <number> | by-thread
14339 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14340 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14341 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14342 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14343 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14344 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14345 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14346 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14347 little bit.
14348
14349 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14350 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14351 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14352 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14353 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14354 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14355
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014356ssl
14357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014358 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014359 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14360 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014361 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14362 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014363
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014364ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14365 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014366 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14367 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14368 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014369 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14370
14371ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014372 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14373 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14374 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14375 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014376
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014377strict-sni
14378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14379 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14380 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14381 See the "crt" option for more information.
14382
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014383tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014384 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014385 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014386 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014387 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014388 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14389 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14390 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14391 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14392 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14393 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14394 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14395
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014396tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014397 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014398 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14399 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14400 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14401 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14402 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14403 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14404 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014405 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14406 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14407 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014408
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014409thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014410 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14411 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14412 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014413
14414 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14415 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14416 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14417 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14418 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14419 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14420 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14421 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14422 of the parsing.
14423
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014424 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014425 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14426 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014427
14428 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14429
14430 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14431 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14432 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14433 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14434 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14435 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14436
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014437tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14438 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014439 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14440 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14441 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14442 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14443 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14444 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14445 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14446 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14447 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14448 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014449 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14450 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14451
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014452transparent
14453 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14454 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14455 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14456 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14457 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14458 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14459 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14460 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14461 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14462 so check for support with your vendor.
14463
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014464v4v6
14465 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14466 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14467 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14468 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014469 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014470
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014471v6only
14472 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14473 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14474 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014475 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14476 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014477
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014478uid <uid>
14479 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14480 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14481 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14482 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14483 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14484
14485user <user>
14486 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14487 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14488 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14489 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14490 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14491
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014492verify [none|optional|required]
14493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14494 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14495 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14496 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14497 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014498 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14499 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14500 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14501 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014502
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200145035.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014504------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014506The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14507which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14508arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14509settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14510after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14511Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14512address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014514 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014515 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014516
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014517Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14518keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014520The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014521
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014522addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014523 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014524 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14525 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14526 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14527 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14528 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014529
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014530agent-check
14531 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014532 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014533 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14534 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14535 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014536
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014537 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014538 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014539 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014540 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14541 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014543 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14544 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14545 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14546 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14547 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014548
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014549 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014550 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014551
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014552 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14553 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14554 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014555
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014556 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14557 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14558 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014559
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014560 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014561 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14562 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14563 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14564 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014565 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014566 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014567
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014568 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14569 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014570
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014571 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14572 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14573 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14574 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14575 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14576 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14577 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14578 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14579 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014580
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014581 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14582 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014583 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14584 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14585 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014586 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014587
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014588 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014589 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014590
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014591agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014592 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014593 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14594 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14595 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14596 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14597
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014598agent-inter <delay>
14599 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14600 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14601
14602 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14603 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14604 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14605 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14606 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14607 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14608 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14609 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14610 of backends use the same servers.
14611
14612 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14613
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014614agent-addr <addr>
14615 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14616
14617 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014618 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014619 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14620 hostname, it will be resolved.
14621
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014622agent-port <port>
14623 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14624
14625 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14626
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014627allow-0rtt
14628 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014629 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14630 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014631
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014632alpn <protocols>
14633 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14634 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14635 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014636 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014637 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14638 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14639 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14640 now obsolete NPN extension.
14641 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14642 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14643
14644 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14645
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014646 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014648backup
14649 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14650 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14651 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14652 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014653 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14654 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014655
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014656ca-file <cafile>
14657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14658 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014659 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14660 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014661 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014662
14663 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
14664 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
14665 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014667check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014668 This option enables health checks on a server:
14669 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14670 considered available.
14671 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14672 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14673 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14674 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14675 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014676 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
14677 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014678 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14679 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14680 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14681 exchanges succeed.
14682
14683 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14684 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14685 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14686 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14687 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014688 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014689 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14690
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014691 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
14692 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitely
14693 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
14694 not overridden.
14695
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014696 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14697 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14698
14699 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14700 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14701
14702 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14703 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14704 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14705 available.
14706
14707 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14708 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14709 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14710
14711 Example:
14712 # simple tcp check
14713 backend foo
14714 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14715 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14716 backend foo
14717 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14718 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14719 backend foo
14720 option tcp-check
14721 tcp-check connect
14722 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014723
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014724check-send-proxy
14725 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14726 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14727 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14728 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14729 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14730 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14731 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14732
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014733check-alpn <protocols>
14734 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14735 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14736 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14737
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014738check-proto <name>
14739 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14740 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14741 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014742 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14743 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14744
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014745 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14746 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14747 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014748
14749 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14750 directive on a server line:
14751
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014752 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014753 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14754 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14755 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14756
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014757 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014758 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14759 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14760
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014761check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014762 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014763 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14764 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014765
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014766check-ssl
14767 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14768 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14769 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14770 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014771 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014772 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14773 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014774 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014775 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14776 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014777
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014778check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014779 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014780 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14781 for normal traffic.
14782
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014783ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14785 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14786 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014787 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14788 information and recommendations see e.g.
14789 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14790 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14791 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014792
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014793ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14795 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14796 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14797 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014798 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14799 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14800 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014802cookie <value>
14803 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14804 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14805 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14806 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14807 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14808 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14809 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14810
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014811crl-file <crlfile>
14812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14813 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14814 to verify server's certificate.
14815
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014816crt <cert>
14817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14818 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14819 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14820 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14821 certificate request.
14822
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014823 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14824 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14825 option is set accordingly).
14826
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014827disabled
14828 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14829 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14830 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14831 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14832 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014833 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014834
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014835enabled
14836 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14837 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14838 default value.
14839 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14840 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014842error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014843 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14844 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14845 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014847 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014849fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014850 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14851 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14852 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14853
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014854force-sslv3
14855 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14856 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014857 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014858 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014859
14860force-tlsv10
14861 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014862 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014863 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014864
14865force-tlsv11
14866 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014867 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014868 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014869
14870force-tlsv12
14871 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014872 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014873 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014874
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014875force-tlsv13
14876 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14877 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014878 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014880id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014881 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14882 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14883 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014884
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014885init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14886 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14887 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014888 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014889 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14890 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14891 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14892 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14893 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14894 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14895 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14896 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14897 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014898 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014899 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14900 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14901 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14902 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14903 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14904 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014905 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014906
14907 Example:
14908 defaults
14909 # never fail on address resolution
14910 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014912inter <delay>
14913fastinter <delay>
14914downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014915 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14916 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14917 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14918 between checks depending on the server state :
14919
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014920 Server state | Interval used
14921 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14922 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14923 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14924 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14925 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14926 or yet unchecked. |
14927 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14928 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14929 | "inter" otherwise.
14930 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014932 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14933 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14934 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14935 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014936 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14937 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14938 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14939 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14940 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014941
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014942log-proto <logproto>
14943 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14944 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14945 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14946 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014948maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014949 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14950 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014951 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14952 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014953 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14954 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14955 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14956 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14957
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014958 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14959 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14960 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14961 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14962 than 50 concurrent requests.
14963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014964maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014965 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14966 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14967 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14968 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014969 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14970 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14971 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14972 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14973 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14974 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14975 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014976
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014977max-reuse <count>
14978 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14979 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14980 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14981 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14982 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14983 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14984 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14985 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014987minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014988 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14989 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14990 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14991 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14992 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14993 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014994 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014995 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014996
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014997namespace <name>
14998 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14999 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15000 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15001 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15002
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015003no-agent-check
15004 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15005 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15006 default value.
15007 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15008 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15009
15010no-backup
15011 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15012 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15013 default value.
15014 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15015 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15016
15017no-check
15018 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15019 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15020 default value.
15021 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15022 "default-server" "check" setting.
15023
15024no-check-ssl
15025 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15026 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15027 default value.
15028 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15029 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15030
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015031no-send-proxy
15032 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15033 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15034 default value.
15035 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15036 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15037
15038no-send-proxy-v2
15039 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15040 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15041 default value.
15042 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15043 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15044
15045no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15046 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15047 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15048 default value.
15049 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15050 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15051
15052no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15053 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15054 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15055 default value.
15056 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15057 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15058
15059no-ssl
15060 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15061 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15062 default value.
15063 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15064 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15065
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015066 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15067 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15068 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15069
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015070no-ssl-reuse
15071 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15072 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15073 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15074 and for paranoid users.
15075
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015076no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015077 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15078 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015079 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015080
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015081 Supported in default-server: No
15082
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015083no-tls-tickets
15084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15085 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15086 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015087 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15088 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015089 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15090 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15091 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015092 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015093
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015094no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015095 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015096 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15097 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015098 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15099 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015100 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015101
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015102 Supported in default-server: No
15103
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015104no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015105 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015106 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15107 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015108 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15109 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015110 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015111
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015112 Supported in default-server: No
15113
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015114no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015115 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015116 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15117 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015118 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15119 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015120 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015121
15122 Supported in default-server: No
15123
15124no-tlsv13
15125 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15126 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15127 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15128 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15129 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015130 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015131
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015132 Supported in default-server: No
15133
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015134no-verifyhost
15135 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15136 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15137 default value.
15138 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15139 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015140
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015141no-tfo
15142 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15143 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15144 default value.
15145 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15146 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15147
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015148non-stick
15149 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15150 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15151 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15152
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015153npn <protocols>
15154 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15155 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15156 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015157 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015158 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15159 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15160 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015162observe <mode>
15163 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15164 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15165 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15166 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15167 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15168 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015169 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015170
15171 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015173on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015174 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15175 Currently, four modes are available:
15176 - fastinter: force fastinter
15177 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15178 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15179 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15180 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15181
15182 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15183
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015184on-marked-down <action>
15185 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15186 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015187 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15188 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15189 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15190 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15191 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15192 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15193 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15194 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015195
15196 Actions are disabled by default
15197
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015198on-marked-up <action>
15199 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15200 Currently one action is available:
15201 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15202 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15203 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15204 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15206 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015207 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15208 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15209
15210 Actions are disabled by default
15211
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015212pool-low-conn <max>
15213 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15214 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15215 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15216 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15217 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15218 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15219 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15220 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15221 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15222 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015223 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15224 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15225 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15226 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015227
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015228pool-max-conn <max>
15229 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15230 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15231 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15232 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15233 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15234 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15235
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015236pool-purge-delay <delay>
15237 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015238 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015239 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015241port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015242 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015243 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15244 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15245 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15246 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15247 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015248
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015249proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015250 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15251 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15252 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015253 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15254 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15255
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015256 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15257 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15258 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015259
15260 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15261 a server line :
15262
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015263 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015264 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15265 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15266 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15267
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015268 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015269 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15270
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015271 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015273redir <prefix>
15274 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15275 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15276 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15277 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15278 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15279 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15280 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15281 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015282 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015283 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015284 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15285 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15286 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15287 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15288
15289 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015291rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015292 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15293 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15294 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15295
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015296resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15297 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15298 server.
15299
15300 Available options:
15301
15302 * allow-dup-ip
15303 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15304 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15305 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15306 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15307 For such case, simply enable this option.
15308 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15309
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015310 * ignore-weight
15311 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15312 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15313 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15314
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015315 * prevent-dup-ip
15316 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15317 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15318 same fqdn.
15319 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15320
15321 Example:
15322 backend b_myapp
15323 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15324 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15325 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15326
15327 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15328 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15329 it
15330 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15331 different address
15332
15333 Default value: not set
15334
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015335resolve-prefer <family>
15336 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15337 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15338 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15339 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15340
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015341 Default value: ipv6
15342
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015343 Example:
15344
15345 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015346
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015347resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015348 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015349 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015350 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015351 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15352 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015353 configured network, another address is selected.
15354
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015355 Example:
15356
15357 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015358
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015359resolvers <id>
15360 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15361 hostname.
15362
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015363 Example:
15364
15365 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015366
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015367 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015368
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015369send-proxy
15370 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15371 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15372 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15373 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015374 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15375 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15376 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15377 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015378 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015379 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15380 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15381 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15382 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15383 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015384 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15385 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015386
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015387send-proxy-v2
15388 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15389 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15390 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15391 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015392 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15393 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15394 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15395 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015396
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015397proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015398 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15399 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15400
15401 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15402 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15403 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15404 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15405 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15406 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15407 connection is supported).
15408 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15409 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15410 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15411 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15412 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15413 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15414 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015415
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015416send-proxy-v2-ssl
15417 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15418 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15419 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15420 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15421 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15422 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15423 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015424 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15425 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015426
15427send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15428 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15429 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15430 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15431 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15432 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15433 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15434 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15435 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015436 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15437 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015439slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015440 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15441 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15442 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15443 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15444 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15445 parameters :
15446
15447 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15448 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15449
15450 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15451 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15452 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15453 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015455 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015456 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15457 seen as failed.
15458
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015459sni <expression>
15460 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15461 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15462 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15463 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015464 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15465 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015466 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015467 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15468 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015469
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015470source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015471source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015472source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015473 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15474 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15475 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15476 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15477
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015478 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15479 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15480 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15481 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15482 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15483 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15484 server.
15485
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015486 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15487 specifying the source address without port(s).
15488
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015489ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015490 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15491 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15492 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15493 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15494 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15495 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015496 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15497 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015498
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015499ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15500 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15501 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15502 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15503
15504ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15505 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15506 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15507 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15508
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015509ssl-reuse
15510 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15511 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15512 default value.
15513 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15514 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15515
15516stick
15517 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15518 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15519 default value.
15520 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15521 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015522
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015523socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015524 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015525 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15526 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15527
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015528tcp-ut <delay>
15529 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015530 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015531 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015532 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015533 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15534 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15535 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15536 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15537 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15538 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15539 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15540 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15541 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15542
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015543tfo
15544 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15545 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15546 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15547 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015548 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015549 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015551track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015552 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15553 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15554 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15555 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015556 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15557
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015558tls-tickets
15559 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15560 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15561 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015562 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15563 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15564 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015565 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015566 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015567
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015568verify [none|required]
15569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015570 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015571 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15572 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015573 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015574 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15575 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15576 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15577 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15578 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15579 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15580 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15581 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015582
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015583verifyhost <hostname>
15584 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015585 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15586 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15587 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15588 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15589 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15590 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15591 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15592 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015594weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015595 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15596 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15597 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015598 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15599 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15600 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15601 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15602 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15603 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015604
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015605ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15606 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15607 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15608 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15609
15610 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15611 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15612 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15613 server ALPN contains it.
15614
15615 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15616 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15617 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15618 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15619
15620 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15621 favor of the ALPN extension.
15622
15623 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015625
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200156265.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15627-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015628
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015629HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15630using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015631configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015632This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15633can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15634workload.
15635This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15636resolution at run time.
15637Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15638carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15639
15640
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200156415.3.1. Global overview
15642----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015643
15644As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15645different steps of the process life:
15646
15647 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15648 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15649 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15650
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015651 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15652 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015653
15654A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15655 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15656 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15657 resolution to know this new IP.
15658
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015659When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015660HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015661SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15662from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015663will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015664will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015665
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015666A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015667 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015668 first valid response.
15669
15670 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15671 servers return an error.
15672
15673
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200156745.3.2. The resolvers section
15675----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015676
15677This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015678HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15679contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015680
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020015681At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
15682no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
15683default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
15684failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
15685
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015686When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15687uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15688is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15689answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15690
15691When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015692used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015693
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015694 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15695 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15696 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015697
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015698 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15699 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015700
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015701 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015702 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15703 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015704
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015705For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15706following scenarios are possible:
15707
15708 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15709 ignored
15710
15711 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15712 applied
15713
15714 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15715 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15716
15717 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15718 retries the query with a new type
15719
15720 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15721 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015722
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015723As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015724a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015725<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015726
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015727
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015728resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015729 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015730
15731A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15732
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015733accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015734 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015735 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015736 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15737 by RFC 6891)
15738
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015739 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15740 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15741 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15742 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15743 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15744 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015745
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015746nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15747 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15748 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15749 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15750 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15751 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15752 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15753 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15754 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15755 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015756 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15757
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015758parse-resolv-conf
15759 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15760 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15761 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15762
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015763hold <status> <period>
15764 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15765 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015766 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015767 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015768 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15769 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15770 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15771
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015772 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015773
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015774resolve_retries <nb>
15775 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15776 giving up.
15777 Default value: 3
15778
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015779 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15780 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15781 type.
15782
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015783timeout <event> <time>
15784 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15785 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15786 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015787 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15788 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015789 Default value: 1s
15790 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015791 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015792 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015793 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15794 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15795
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015796 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015797
15798 resolvers mydns
15799 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15800 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015801 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015802 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015803 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015804 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015805 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015806 hold other 30s
15807 hold refused 30s
15808 hold nx 30s
15809 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015810 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015811 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015812
15813
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200158146. Cache
15815---------
15816
15817HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15818(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15819RAM.
15820
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015821The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15822blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015823
15824If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15825independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15826when we try to allocate a new one.
15827
15828The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15829
15830It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15831"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15832for more details.
15833
15834When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15835replaced by "<CACHE>".
15836
15837
158386.1. Limitation
15839----------------
15840
15841The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15842
15843- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015844- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15845 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15846 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015847- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15848- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015849- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15850 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15851 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015852- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15853 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015854- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15855 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15856 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015857
15858- If the request is not a GET
15859- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15860- If the request contains an Authorization header
15861
15862
158636.2. Setup
15864-----------
15865
15866To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15867the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15868
15869
158706.2.1. Cache section
15871---------------------
15872
15873cache <name>
15874 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15875 size of cache is mandatory.
15876
15877total-max-size <megabytes>
15878 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15879 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15880
15881max-object-size <bytes>
15882 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15883 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15884 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15885
15886max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015887 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015888 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15889 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15890 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15891 default.
15892
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015893process-vary <on/off>
15894 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015895 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15896 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15897 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015898 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015899
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015900max-secondary-entries <number>
15901 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15902 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15903 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15904
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015905
159066.2.2. Proxy section
15907---------------------
15908
15909http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15910 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15911 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15912 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15913 after this one.
15914
15915http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15916 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15917 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15918 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15919 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15920
15921
15922Example:
15923
15924 backend bck1
15925 mode http
15926
15927 http-request cache-use foobar
15928 http-response cache-store foobar
15929 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15930
15931 cache foobar
15932 total-max-size 4
15933 max-age 240
15934
15935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159367. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15937----------------------------------
15938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015939HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15941The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15942these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15943but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15944data called patterns.
15945
15946
159477.1. ACL basics
15948---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015949
15950The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15951content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15952from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15953simple :
15954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015956 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15958 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15961adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015962
15963In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015966
15967This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15968Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15969and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015970an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15971conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15972as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15973are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015974
15975ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15976'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15977which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15978
15979There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15980performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15983specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15984this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015985methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15986ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987
15988Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15989 - boolean
15990 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15991 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15992 - string
15993 - data block
15994
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015995Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15996converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15997would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15998The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15999which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16000
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016001Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16002keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16003fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16004which are summarized in the table below :
16005
16006 +---------------------+-----------------+
16007 | Sample or converter | Default |
16008 | output type | matching method |
16009 +---------------------+-----------------+
16010 | boolean | bool |
16011 +---------------------+-----------------+
16012 | integer | int |
16013 +---------------------+-----------------+
16014 | ip | ip |
16015 +---------------------+-----------------+
16016 | string | str |
16017 +---------------------+-----------------+
16018 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16019 +---------------------+-----------------+
16020
16021Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16022matching method, see below.
16023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016024The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16025 - boolean
16026 - integer or integer range
16027 - IP address / network
16028 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16029 - regular expression
16030 - hex block
16031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016032The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16033
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016034 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16035 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016037 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016038 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016039 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016040 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016042The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16043read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16044if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16045lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16046will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16047beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016048a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16050exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16051
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016052The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16053parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16054ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16055a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16056check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16057
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016058The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16059socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16060file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16063loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16064
16065 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16066
16067In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16068the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16069case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16070as well.
16071
16072The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16073sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16074do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16075methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16076is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016077obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16079default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16080that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16081string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16082
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016083The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16084By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16085string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16086resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016087server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016088waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016089flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16090function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16093sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16094be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016095
16096 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16097 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16099 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16100 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16101 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016102
16103 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16104 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016106
16107 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016109
16110 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016112
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016113 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016114 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16115
16116 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16117 binary or string samples.
16118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16120 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16123 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16124 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16127 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16130 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16133 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16136 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016137 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16140 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16141 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016142
16143For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16144request, it is possible to do :
16145
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016146 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016147
16148In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16149buffer, one would use the following acl :
16150
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016151 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016152
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016153On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16154possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16155
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016156 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16159criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16160method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
16161to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
16162criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16163the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016166the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16167For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16170 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16171 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16172 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016173
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016174
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016175The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16176types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16177combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16178brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16179default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181 +-------------------------------------------------+
16182 | Input sample type |
16183 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016184 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16186 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16187 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016188 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016190 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016192 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016194 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016196 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016198 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016200 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016202 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016204 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016206 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016208 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16210 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16211 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016212
16213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162147.1.1. Matching booleans
16215------------------------
16216
16217In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16218Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16219When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16220that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16221
16222Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16223return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16224"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16225
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162277.1.2. Matching integers
16228------------------------
16229
16230Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16231enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16232to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16233
16234Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16235matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16236lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016237
16238For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16239unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16240representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16241
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016242As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16243two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16244instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16245ranges and operators.
16246
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016247For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016248operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16249Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16250of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016252Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016253
16254 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16255 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16256 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16257 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16258 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016260For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016261
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016262 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016263
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016264This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16265
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016266 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016267
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162697.1.3. Matching strings
16270-----------------------
16271
16272String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16273different forms :
16274
16275 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016276 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277
16278 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016279 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280
16281 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16282 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16283
16284 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16285 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16286
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016287 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016288 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16289 matches.
16290
16291 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16292 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16293 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016294
16295String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16296exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16297characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16298string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16299to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016300before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016301
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016302Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16303(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16304Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16305
16306Example:
16307 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16308 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16309
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163117.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16312---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016313
16314Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16315they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16316possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16317passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16318the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016319the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16320match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016321
16322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163237.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16324-------------------------------------
16325
16326It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16327not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16328a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16329to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16330digits may be used upper or lower case.
16331
16332Example :
16333 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016334 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016335
16336
163377.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16338---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016339
16340IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16341netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16342within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016343host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016344difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16345at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16346does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16347parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016348
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016349The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16350abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16351
16352 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16353 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16354 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16355 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16356 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16357 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16358 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16359 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16360
16361Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16362192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16363
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016364IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16365Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16366trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16367IPv6 patterns.
16368
16369HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16370following situations :
16371 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16372 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16373 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16374 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16375 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16376 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16377 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16378 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16379 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16380 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382
163837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16384----------------------------------
16385
16386Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16387combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16388
16389 - AND (implicit)
16390 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16391 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16398indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16401"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16402requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16403is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16404
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016405 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016406 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16407 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16408 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409
16410To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16411and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16412
16413 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16414 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16415 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16416 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016418 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016419 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16420 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16421 use_backend www if host_www
16422
16423It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16424expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16425be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16426the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16427
16428 The following rule :
16429
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016430 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016431 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432
16433 Can also be written that way :
16434
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016435 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436
16437It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16438to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16439simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16440sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16441good use is the following :
16442
16443 With named ACLs :
16444
16445 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16446 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16447 monitor fail if site_dead
16448
16449 With anonymous ACLs :
16450
16451 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16452
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016453See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16454keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455
16456
164577.3. Fetching samples
16458---------------------
16459
16460Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16461against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16462sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16463ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16464of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16465available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16466
16467This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16468Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16469compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16470deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16471
16472The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16473matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16474method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16475indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16476
16477As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16478when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16479mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16480the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16481ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16482
16483Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16484multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16485when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016486incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16487are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16489all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16490
16491Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16492 - name
16493 - name(arg1)
16494 - name(arg1,arg2)
16495
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016496
164977.3.1. Converters
16498-----------------
16499
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016500Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16501of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16502is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16503was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016504has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016505unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16506
16507These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16508sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16509the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016510support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016511
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016512A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16513support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16514supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16515(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16516bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016519
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001652051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16521 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16522 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16523 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16524 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16525 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16526
16527 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016528 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16529 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016530 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16531 frontend http-in
16532 bind *:8081
16533 default_backend servers
16534 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16535 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16536
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016537add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016538 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016539 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016540 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16541 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016542 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016543 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16544 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16545 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16546 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016547 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016548 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016549
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016550add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16551 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16552 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16553 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
16554 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
16555 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16556 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
16557 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
16558 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
16559 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
16560 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
16561 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
16562 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
16563 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
16564 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
16565 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
16566 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
16567 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16568 level parser. See examples below.
16569
16570 Example:
16571 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
16572 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
16573 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
16574 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
16575
16576 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
16577 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
16578
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016579aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16580 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16581 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16582 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16583 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16584 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16585 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16586
16587 Example:
16588 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16589 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16590
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016591and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016592 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016593 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016594 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16595 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016596 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016597 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16598 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16599 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16600 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016601 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016602 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016603
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016604b64dec
16605 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16606 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016607 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16608 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016609
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016610base64
16611 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016612 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016613 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16614 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016615
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016616be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16617 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16618 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16619 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16620 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16621 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16622
16623 Example:
16624 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16625 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16626 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16627 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16628
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016629be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16630 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16631 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16632 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16633 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16634 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16635 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16636
16637 Example:
16638 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16639 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16640 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16641 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16642
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016643bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016644 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016645 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016646 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016647 presence of a flag).
16648
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016649bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16650 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16651 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016652 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016653
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016654concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16655 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16656 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16657 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16658 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16659 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16660 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16661 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16662 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16663 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16664 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016665 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016666 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016667 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016668 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16669 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16670 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016671
16672 Example:
16673 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16674 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16675 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016676 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016677 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016678 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16679
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016680cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016681 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16682 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016683
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016684crc32([<avalanche>])
16685 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16686 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16687 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16688 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16689 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16690 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16691 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16692 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16693 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16694 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016695 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16696
16697crc32c([<avalanche>])
16698 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16699 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16700 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16701 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16702 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16703 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16704 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16705 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016706
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016707cut_crlf
16708 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16709 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16710 updated.
16711
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016712da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016713 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16714 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16715 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16716 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016717 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016718 configuration language.
16719
16720 Example:
16721 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016722 bind *:8881
16723 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016724 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016725
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016726debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16727 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16728 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16729 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16730 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16731 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16732 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16733 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16734 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16735 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16736 printable sample types.
16737
16738 Example:
16739 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016740
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016741digest(<algorithm>)
16742 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16743 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16744
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016745 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016746 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16747
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016748div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016749 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16750 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016751 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016752 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16753 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016754 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016755 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16756 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16757 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16758 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016759 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016760 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016761
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016762djb2([<avalanche>])
16763 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16764 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16765 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16766 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16767 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16768 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16769 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016770 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16771 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016772
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016773even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016774 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016775 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16776
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016777field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16778 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16779 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16780 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16781 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16782 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16783 fields.
16784
16785 Example :
16786 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16787 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16788 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16789 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16790 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016791
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016792fix_is_valid
16793 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16794 Information eXchange):
16795
16796 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16797 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016798 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016799 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016800 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016801 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16802 checksum
16803
16804 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16805 the server can be parsed.
16806
16807 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16808 message, false if not.
16809
16810 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16811
16812 Example:
16813 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16814 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16815
16816fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16817 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16818 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16819 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16820 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016821 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016822 added.
16823
16824 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16825 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16826 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16827 fix_is_valid converter.
16828
16829 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16830
16831 Example:
16832 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16833 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16834 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16835 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16836 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16837
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016838hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016839 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016840 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016841 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016842 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016843
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016844hex2i
16845 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016846 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016847
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016848htonl
16849 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16850 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16851 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16852 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16853
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016854hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016855 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16856 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16857 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16858 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16859
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016860 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016861 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16862
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016863http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016864 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16865 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016866 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16867 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16868 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16869 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16870 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16871 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16872 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16873 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016875iif(<true>,<false>)
16876 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16877 string otherwise.
16878
16879 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016880 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016881
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016882in_table(<table>)
16883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16885 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016886 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016887 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16888
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016889ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016890 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016891 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016892 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16893 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16894 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16895 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16896 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016897
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016898json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016899 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016900 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016901 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016902 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16903 of errors:
16904 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16905 bytes, ...)
16906 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16907 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16908
16909 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16910 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16911 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16912 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16913 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16914 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016915 - "ascii" : never fails;
16916 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16917 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016918 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016919 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016920 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16921 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16922
16923 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016924 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016925
16926 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016927 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016928 capture request header user-agent len 150
16929 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016930
16931 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16932 GET / HTTP/1.0
16933 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16934
16935 Output log:
16936 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16937
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016938json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16939 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16940 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16941 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16942 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16943
16944 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16945 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16946
16947 Example:
16948 # get a integer value from the request body
16949 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16950 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16951
16952 # get a key with '.' in the name
16953 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16954 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16955
16956 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16957 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16958
16959 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16960 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016962jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16963 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16964 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16965 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16966 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16967 json_path and output_type parameters.
16968
16969 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16970 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16971
16972jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16973 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16974 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16975 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16976 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16977 json_path and output_type parameters.
16978
16979 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16980 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16981
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016982jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16983 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16984 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016985 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016986 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16987 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16988 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16989 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016990
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016991 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16992 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16993 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16994 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016995
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016996 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16997 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16998 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16999 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17000 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17001 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017002 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017003 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17004
17005 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17006 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17007 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17008 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17009 contents.
17010
17011 The possible return values are the following :
17012
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017013 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17014 | ID | message |
17015 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017016 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017017 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017018 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17019 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17020 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17021 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17022 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017023 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017024
17025 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17026 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17027
17028 Example:
17029 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17030 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17031 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17032 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17033 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17034 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17035
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017036language(<value>[,<default>])
17037 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17038 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17039 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17040 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17041 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17042 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17043 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17044 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17045 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017046 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017047 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17048 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017049
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017050 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017052 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17053 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017054
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017055 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17056 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17057 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17058 use_backend spanish if es
17059 use_backend french if fr
17060 use_backend english if en
17061 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017062
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017063length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017064 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17065 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17066 type. The result is of type integer.
17067
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017068lower
17069 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17070 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17071 type. The result is of type string.
17072
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017073ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17074 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17075 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17076 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17077 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17078 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17079 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17080
17081 Example :
17082
17083 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017085 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17086
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017087ltrim(<chars>)
17088 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17089 representation of the input sample.
17090
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017091map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17092map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17093map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17094 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17095 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17096 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17097 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17098 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17099 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17100 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17101 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017103 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17104 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17105 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017106
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017107 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017108 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017109
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017110 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17111 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17112 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17113 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017114 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17115 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017116 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17117 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17118 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17119 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17120 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17121 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17122 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17123 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017124 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17125 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17126 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017127 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17128 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17129 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17130 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17131 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017132
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017133 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17134 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17135 the corresponding match text.
17136
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017137 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17138 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17139 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17140 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17141 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017142
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017143 Example :
17144
17145 # this is a comment and is ignored
17146 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17147 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17148 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17149 | | | `---------- value
17150 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17151 | `---------------------------- key
17152 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17153
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017154mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017155 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17156 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017157 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017158 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017159 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017160 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17161 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17162 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17163 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017164 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017165 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017166
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017167mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017168 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17169 <packettype>.
17170 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17171 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17172 from.
17173 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17174 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17175 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17176
17177 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17178 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17179 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17180 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17181
17182 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17183 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17184 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17185 packets only):
17186 17: Session Expiry Interval
17187 33: Receive Maximum
17188 39: Maximum Packet Size
17189 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17190 25: Request Response Information
17191 23: Request Problem Information
17192 21: Authentication Method
17193 22: Authentication Data
17194 18: Will Delay Interval
17195 1: Payload Format Indicator
17196 2: Message Expiry Interval
17197 3: Content Type
17198 8: Response Topic
17199 9: Correlation Data
17200 Not supported yet:
17201 38: User Property
17202
17203 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17204 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17205 packets only):
17206 17: Session Expiry Interval
17207 33: Receive Maximum
17208 36: Maximum QoS
17209 37: Retain Available
17210 39: Maximum Packet Size
17211 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17212 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17213 31: Reason String
17214 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17215 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17216 42: Shared Subscription Available
17217 19: Server Keep Alive
17218 26: Response Information
17219 28: Server Reference
17220 21: Authentication Method
17221 22: Authentication Data
17222 Not supported yet:
17223 38: User Property
17224
17225 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17226 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17227 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17228 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17229
17230 Example:
17231
17232 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17233 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17234 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17235 if data_in_buffer
17236 # do the same as above
17237 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17238 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17239 if data_in_buffer
17240
17241mqtt_is_valid
17242 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17243
17244 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17245 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17246 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17247 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17248
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017249 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17250
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017251 Example:
17252
17253 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017254 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017255
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017256mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017257 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017258 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17259 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017260 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017261 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17265 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17266 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017267 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017268 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017269
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017270nbsrv
17271 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17272 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17273 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17274 map lookup.
17275
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017276neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017277 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17278 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17279 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17280 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017281
17282not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017283 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017284 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017285 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017286 absence of a flag).
17287
17288odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017289 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017290 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17291
17292or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017293 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017294 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017295 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17296 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17300 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17301 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017302 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017303 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017304
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017305protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17306 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17307 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17308 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17309 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17310 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17311 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17312 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17313 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17314 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17315 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17316 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17317
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017318regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017319 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17320 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17321 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17322 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17323 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17324 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17325 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17326 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17327 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017328 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17329 of characters with other ones.
17330
17331 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17332 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17333 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17334 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17335 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17336 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017337
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017338 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017339
17340 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17341 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17342 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017343 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017344
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017345 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17346 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17347
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017348 # capture groups and backreferences
17349 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017350 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017351 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17352
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017353capture-req(<id>)
17354 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17355 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17356
17357 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017358 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17359 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017360
17361capture-res(<id>)
17362 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17363 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17364
17365 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017366 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17367 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017368
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017369rtrim(<chars>)
17370 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17371 of the input sample.
17372
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017373sdbm([<avalanche>])
17374 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17375 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17376 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17377 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17378 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17379 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17380 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017381 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17382 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017383
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017384secure_memcmp(<var>)
17385 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17386 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17387 match.
17388
17389 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17390 performed in constant time.
17391
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017392 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017393 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17394
17395 Example :
17396
17397 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17398 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17399 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17400 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17401
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017402set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017403 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017404 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17405 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17406 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17407 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017408 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017409 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17410 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017411 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017412 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17413 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017414 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017415 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017416
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017417 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17418 possible conditions :
17419 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17420 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17421 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17422 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17423 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17424 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17425 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17426 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17427 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17428 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17429 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17430 called on the variable.
17431 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17432 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17433 configuration parsing.
17434 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17435 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17436 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17437 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17438 true by default.
17439
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017440sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017441 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017442 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17443
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017444sha2([<bits>])
17445 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17446 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17447
17448 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17449 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17450
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017451 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017452 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17453
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017454srv_queue
17455 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17456 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17457 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17458 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17459 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17460
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017461strcmp(<var>)
17462 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17463 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17464 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17465 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17466 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17467 shorter).
17468
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017469 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17470 strings in constant time.
17471
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017472 Example :
17473
17474 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17475 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17476 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17477
17478
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017479sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017480 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17481 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017482 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017483 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17484 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017485 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017486 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17487 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017488 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017489 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17490 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017491 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017492 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017493
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017494table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17495 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17496 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17497 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17498 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17499 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17500 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17501
17502
17503table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17504 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17505 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17506 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17507 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17508 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17509 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17510
17511table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17512 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17513 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017514 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017515 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17516 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17517
17518table_conn_cur(<table>)
17519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17521 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17522 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17523 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17524
17525table_conn_rate(<table>)
17526 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17527 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17528 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17529 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17530 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17531
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017532table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17536 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17537 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17538 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17539 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17540 data-type).
17541 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17542
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017543table_gpt0(<table>)
17544 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17545 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17546 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17547 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17548 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17549
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017550table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17551 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17552 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17553 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17554 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17555 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17556 between 0 and 99.
17557 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17558 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17559 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17560 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17561
17562table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17565 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17566 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17567 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17568 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17569 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17570 value 0.
17571 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17572 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17573 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17574
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017575table_gpc0(<table>)
17576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17579 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17580 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17581
17582table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17586 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17587 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17588 sample fetch keyword.
17589
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017590table_gpc1(<table>)
17591 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17592 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17593 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17594 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17595 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17596
17597table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17598 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17599 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17600 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17601 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17602 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17603 sample fetch keyword.
17604
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017605table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17606 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17607 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017608 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017609 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17610 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17611
17612table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17613 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17614 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17615 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17616 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17617 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17618 keyword.
17619
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017620table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17621 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17622 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17623 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17624 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17625 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17626
17627table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17628 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17629 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17630 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17631 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17632 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17633 keyword.
17634
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017635table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17636 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17637 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017638 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017639 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17640 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17641
17642table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17643 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17644 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17645 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17646 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17647 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17648 keyword.
17649
17650table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17651 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17652 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017653 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017654 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17655 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17656 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17657 keyword.
17658
17659table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17660 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17661 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017662 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017663 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17664 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17665 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17666 keyword.
17667
17668table_server_id(<table>)
17669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17672 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17673 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17674 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17675
17676table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017680 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17681 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17682 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17683 keyword.
17684
17685table_sess_rate(<table>)
17686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17689 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17690 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17691 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17692 keyword.
17693
17694table_trackers(<table>)
17695 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17696 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17697 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17698 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17699 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17700 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17701 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17702 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17703 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17704 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17705
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017706ub64dec
17707 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17708 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17709 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17710
17711 Example:
17712 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17713 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17714
17715ub64enc
17716 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17717
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017718upper
17719 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17720 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17721 type. The result is of type string.
17722
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017723url_dec([<in_form>])
17724 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17725 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17726 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17727 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17728 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17729 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017730
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017731url_enc([<enc_type>])
17732 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17733 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17734 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17735 optional argument is here for future changes.
17736
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017737ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017738 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017739 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17740 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17741 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017742 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17743 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17744 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17745 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017746 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017747 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17748 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017749
17750 Example:
17751 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17752 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17753
17754 message Point {
17755 int32 latitude = 1;
17756 int32 longitude = 2;
17757 }
17758
17759 message PPoint {
17760 Point point = 59;
17761 }
17762
17763 message Rectangle {
17764 // One corner of the rectangle.
17765 PPoint lo = 48;
17766 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17767 PPoint hi = 49;
17768 }
17769
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017770 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17771 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17772 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017773
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017774 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17775 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017776 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017777 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17778
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017779 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017780
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017781 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017782
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017783 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17784 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17785 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017786
17787 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17788 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17789 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17790
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017791 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17792 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17793 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017794
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017795
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017796unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017797 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17798 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17799 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17800 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17801 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17802 response),
17803 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17804 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17805 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17806 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17807
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017808utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17809 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17810 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17811 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17812 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17813 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17814 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17815
17816 Example :
17817
17818 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017819 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017820 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17821
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017822word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17823 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17824 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17825 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017826 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017827 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17828 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17829
17830 Example :
17831 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17832 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17833 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17834 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17835 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017836 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017837
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017838wt6([<avalanche>])
17839 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17840 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17841 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17842 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17843 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17844 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17845 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017846 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17847 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017848
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017849xor(<value>)
17850 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017851 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017852 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017853 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017857 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017861 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017862
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017863xxh3([<seed>])
17864 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17865 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17866 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17867 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17868 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17869 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17870 considered as cryptographically secure.
17871
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017872xxh32([<seed>])
17873 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17874 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17875 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17876 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17877 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17878 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17879 as cryptographically secure.
17880
17881xxh64([<seed>])
17882 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17883 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17884 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17885 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17886 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17887 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17888 as cryptographically secure.
17889
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017890
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178917.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892--------------------------------------------
17893
17894A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17895not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17896"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17897The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17898
17899always_false : boolean
17900 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17901 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17902
17903always_true : boolean
17904 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17905 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17906
17907avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017908 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017909 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17910 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17911 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17912 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17913 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17914 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17915 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17916 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17917 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17918 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17919 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17920 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17921 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017923be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017924 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17925 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17926 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17927 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017928 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17929
17930be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17932 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17933 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17934 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17935 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017936 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17937 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017938
17939 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17940 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17941 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017943be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17945 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17946 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017947 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017948 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17949 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017950
17951 Example :
17952 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17953 backend dynamic
17954 mode http
17955 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17956 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017958bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017959 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17960 of the string.
17961
17962bool(<bool>) : bool
17963 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17964 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017968 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17970 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017971
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017972 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017973 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017974 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17975
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017976 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17977 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017978
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017979 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017980 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017982 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017983 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017984 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017985 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017986
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017987 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17988 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017990 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017991
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017992cpu_calls : integer
17993 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17994 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17995 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17996 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17997 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17998 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17999
18000cpu_ns_avg : integer
18001 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18002 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18003 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18004 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18005 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18006 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18007 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18008 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18009 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18010 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18011 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18012
18013cpu_ns_tot : integer
18014 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18015 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18016 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18017 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18018 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18019 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18020 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18021 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18022 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18023 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18024 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18025 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18026 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18027
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018028date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018029 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018030
18031 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18032 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18033 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018034 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18035
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018036 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18037 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18038 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18039 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18040 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18041
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018042 Example :
18043
18044 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18045 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018046
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018047 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18048 # millisecond granularity
18049 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18050
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018051date_us : integer
18052 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18053 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18054 from the same timeval structure.
18055
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018056env(<name>) : string
18057 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18058 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18059 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18060 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18061 certain way.
18062
18063 Examples :
18064 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18065 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18066
18067 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018068 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18071 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018072 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18073 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18075 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18078 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018079
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018080fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18081 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18082 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18083 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18087 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18088 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18089 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18090 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18091 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18092 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18093 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018094
18095 Example :
18096 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18097 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18098 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18099 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18100 frontend mail
18101 bind :25
18102 mode tcp
18103 maxconn 100
18104 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18105 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18106 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18107 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018108
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018109hostname : string
18110 Returns the system hostname.
18111
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018112int(<integer>) : signed integer
18113 Returns a signed integer.
18114
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018115ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18116 Returns an ipv4.
18117
18118ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18119 Returns an ipv6.
18120
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018121last_rule_file: string
18122 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18123 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18124 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18125 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18126 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18127 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18128 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18129 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18130 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18131 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18132 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18133 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18134
18135last_rule_line: integer
18136 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18137 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18138 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18139 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18140 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18141 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18142 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18143 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18144 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18145 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18146 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18147 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18148
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018149lat_ns_avg : integer
18150 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18151 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18152 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18153 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18154 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18155 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18156 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18157 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18158 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018159 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18160 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18161 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18162 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18163 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18164 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018165
18166lat_ns_tot : integer
18167 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18168 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18169 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18170 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18171 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18172 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18173 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18174 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18175 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018176 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18177 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18178 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18179 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18180 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018181 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18182 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18183 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18184 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18185 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18186 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18187
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018188meth(<method>) : method
18189 Returns a method.
18190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018191nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18192 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18193 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18194 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018195 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18196 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18197 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018198
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018199prio_class : integer
18200 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18201 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18202 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18203
18204prio_offset : integer
18205 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18206 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18207 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18208 set-priority-offset".
18209
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018210proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018211 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18212 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018215 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18216 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18217 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18219 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18220 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18221 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18222 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18223
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018224rand([<range>]) : integer
18225 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18226 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18227 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18228 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18229 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18233 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18234 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18235 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18236 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018237 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18238 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18239
18240srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18242 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18243 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18244 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18245 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18246 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18247 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18248
18249 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18250 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251
18252srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18253 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18254 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18255 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018256 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018257 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18258 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18259 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18260
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018261srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18262 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18263 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18264 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18265 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18266 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18267 fetch methods.
18268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18270 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18271 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018272 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18274 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018275 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276 overloading servers).
18277
18278 Example :
18279 # Redirect to a separate back
18280 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18281 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18282 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18283
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018284srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018285 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18286 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18287 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18288
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018289srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018290 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18291 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18292 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18293
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018294srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018295 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18296 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18297 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18298
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018299stopping : boolean
18300 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18301 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18302 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18303
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018304str(<string>) : string
18305 Returns a string.
18306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18308 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18309 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18310
18311table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18312 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18313 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18314 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18315
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018316thread : integer
18317 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18318 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18319 and debugging purposes.
18320
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018321uuid([<version>]) : string
18322 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18323 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18324 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18325
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018326var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018327 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018328 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18329 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18330 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018331 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018332 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18333 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018334 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018335 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18336 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018338 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018339
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018341----------------------------------
18342
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018343The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18345methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18346sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18347TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018348the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18349counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018350"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18351used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18352can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18353Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18354table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18355tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18356currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018358bc_dst : ip
18359 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18360 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18361 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18362 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18363
18364bc_dst_port : integer
18365 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018366 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018367
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018368bc_err : integer
18369 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18370 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18371 and their corresponding error message.
18372
18373bc_err_str : string
18374 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18375 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18376 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18377 corresponding error message.
18378
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018379bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018380 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18381 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18382 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18383
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018384bc_src : ip
18385 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018386 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018387 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18388 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18389
18390bc_src_port : integer
18391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018392 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394be_id : integer
18395 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018396 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18397 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018398
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018399be_name : string
18400 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018401 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18402 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018403
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018404be_server_timeout : integer
18405 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18406 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18407 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18408
18409be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18410 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18411 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18412 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18413
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018414cur_server_timeout : integer
18415 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18416 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18417 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18418
18419cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18420 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18421 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18422 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018425 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18426 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18427 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18428 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18429 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18430 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18431 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18432 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18433 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18434 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18435 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018436
18437dst_conn : integer
18438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18439 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18440 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18441 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18442 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18443 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18444 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18445 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018446
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018447dst_is_local : boolean
18448 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18449 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18450 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18451 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018452 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018453 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18454 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18455 it only once per connection.
18456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457dst_port : integer
18458 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18459 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018460 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18461 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18462 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18463 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018464
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018465fc_dst : ip
18466 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18467 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18468 for details.
18469
18470fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18471 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18472 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18473 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18474
18475fc_dst_port : integer
18476 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18477 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18478 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18479
18480fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018481 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18482 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18483 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018484 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018485 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18486
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018487fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018488 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018489 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018490 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018491 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18492
18493 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18494 | ID | message |
18495 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18496 | 0 | "Success" |
18497 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18498 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18499 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18500 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18501 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18502 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18503 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18504 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18505 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18506 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18507 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18508 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18509 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18510 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18511 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18512 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18513 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18514 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18515 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18516 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18517 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18518 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18519 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18520 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18521 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18522 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18523 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18524 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18525 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18526 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18527 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18528 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18529 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18530 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18531 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18532 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18533 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18534 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18535 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18536 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18537 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18538 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018539 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018540 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18541
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018542fc_fackets : integer
18543 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18544 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18545 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18546 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18547
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018548fc_http_major : integer
18549 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18550 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18551 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18552
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018553fc_lost : integer
18554 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18555 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18556 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18557 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18558
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018559fc_pp_authority : string
18560 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18561 if any.
18562
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018563fc_pp_unique_id : string
18564 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18565 if any.
18566
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018567fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18568 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18569 header.
18570
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018571fc_reordering : integer
18572 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18573 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18574 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18575 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18576
18577fc_retrans : integer
18578 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18579 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18580 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18581 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18582
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018583fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18584 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18585 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18586 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18587 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18588 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18589 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18590
18591fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18592 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18593 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18594 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18595 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18596 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18597 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18598
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018599fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018600 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18601 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18602 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18603 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18604
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018605fc_src : ip
18606 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18607 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18608 for details.
18609
18610fc_src_is_local : boolean
18611 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18612 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18613 "src_is_local" for details.
18614
18615fc_src_port : integer
18616
18617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18618 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18619 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18620
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018621
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018622fc_unacked : integer
18623 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18624 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18625 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18626 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018627
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018628fe_defbe : string
18629 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18630 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632fe_id : integer
18633 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018634 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18636
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018637fe_name : string
18638 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18639 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18640 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18641
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018642fe_client_timeout : integer
18643 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18644 current frontend.
18645
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018646sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018647sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18648sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18649sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018650 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18651 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18652 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018654sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018655sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18656sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18657sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018658 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18659 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18660 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18661
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018662sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18663 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18664 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18665 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18666 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18667 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18668 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18669 will always return zero.
18670 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18671 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018673sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018674sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18675sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18676sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018677 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18678 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018679 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18680 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18681 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018682
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018683 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018684 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18685 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018686 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18687 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18688 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018689 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18690 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18691
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018692sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18693sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18694sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18695sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18696 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18697 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18698 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18699 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18700 when a first ACL was verified.
18701
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018702sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018703sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18704sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18705sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018706 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018707 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018709sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018710sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18711sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18712sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018713 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18714 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18715 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018717sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018718sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18719sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18720sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018721 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18722 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18723 See also src_conn_rate.
18724
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018725sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18726 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18727 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18728 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18729 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18730 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18731 index, zero is returned.
18732 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18733 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018735sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018736sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18737sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18738sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018739 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018740 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018741
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018742sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18743sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18744sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18745sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18746 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18747 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18748
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018749sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18750 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18751 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18752 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18753 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18754 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18755 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18756 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18757
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018758sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18759sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18760sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18761sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18762 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18763 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18764
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018765sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18766 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18767 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18768 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18769 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18770 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18771 between 0 and 2.
18772 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18773 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18774 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18775 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18776 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018778sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018779sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18780sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18781sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018782 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18783 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18784 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018785 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18786 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18787 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018788
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018789sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18790sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18791sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18792sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18793 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18794 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18795 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18796 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18797 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18798 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018800sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018801sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18802sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18803sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018804 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018805 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18806 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18807
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018808sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018809sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18810sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18811sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018812 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18813 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18814 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18815 src_http_err_rate.
18816
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018817sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18818sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18819sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18820sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18821 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18822 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18823 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18824
18825sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18826sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18827sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18828sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18829 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18830 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18831 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18832 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018834sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018835sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18836sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18837sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018838 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018839 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18840 src_http_req_cnt.
18841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018842sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018843sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18844sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18845sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018846 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18847 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18848 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18849 src_http_req_rate.
18850
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018851sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18852 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18853 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18854 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18855 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18856 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18857 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18858 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18859 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18860 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018862sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018863sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18864sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18865sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018866 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018867 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18868 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18869 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18870 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018871
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018872 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018873 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18874 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018875 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18876
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018877sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18878sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18879sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18880sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18881 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18882 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18883 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18884 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18885 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018887sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018888sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18889sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18890sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018891 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18892 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18893 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018894
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018895sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018896sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18897sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18898sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018899 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18900 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18901 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018902
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018903sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018904sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18905sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18906sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018907 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018908 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18909 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18910 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018911 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018912 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18913
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018914sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018915sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18916sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18917sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018918 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18919 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18920 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18921 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18922 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018923 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018924
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018925sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018926sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18927sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18928sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018929 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18930 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18931 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18932
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018933sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018934sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18935sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18936sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018937 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18938 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018939 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018940 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18941 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018942 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18943 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18944 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018946so_id : integer
18947 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18948 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18949 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018950
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018951so_name : string
18952 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18953 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18954 strings instead of integers.
18955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018957 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18958 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18959 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18960 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18961 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18962 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18963 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18964 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18965 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18966 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18967 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18968 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18969 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18970 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18971 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018972
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018973 Example:
18974 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18975 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18978 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18979 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18980 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018981 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018983src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18984 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18985 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018986 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018987 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018988
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018989src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18990 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18991 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18992 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18993 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18994 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18995 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18996 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18997 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19000 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19001 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19002 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19003 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19004 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19005 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019006
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019007 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019008 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19009 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19010 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19011 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019012 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019013 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19014 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19015
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019016src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19017 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19018 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19019 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19020 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19021 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19022 was verified.
19023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019024src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019025 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019026 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019027 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019028 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019030src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019031 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19033 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019034 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019036src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19037 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19038 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19039 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019040 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019041
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019042src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19043 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19044 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19045 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19046 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19047 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19048 is returned.
19049 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19050 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19051 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019054 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019055 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019056 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019057 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019058
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019059src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19060 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19061 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19062 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19063 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19064
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019065src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19066 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19067 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19068 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19069 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19070 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19071 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19072
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019073src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19074 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19075 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19076 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19077 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19078
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019079src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19080 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19081 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19082 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19083 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19084 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19085 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19086 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19087 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19088 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19089 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019092 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019093 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019094 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19095 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019096 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19097 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19098 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019099
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019100src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19101 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19102 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19103 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19104 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19105 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19106 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19107 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019110 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019111 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019112 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019113 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019114 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19117 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19118 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19119 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19120 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019121 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019122
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019123src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19124 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19125 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019126 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019127 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19128 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19129
19130src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19131 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19132 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19133 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19134 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19135 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19136 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019138src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019139 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19141 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019142 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019144src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19145 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19146 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19147 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019148 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019149 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019150
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019151src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19152 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19153 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19154 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19155 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19156 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19157 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19158 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19159 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019161src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19162 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19163 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19164 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019165 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019166 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19167 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019168
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019169 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019170 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019171 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019172 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019173
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019174src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19175 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19176 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19177 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19178 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19179 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19180 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19181
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019182src_is_local : boolean
19183 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19184 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19185 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19186 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019187 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019188 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19189 once per connection.
19190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019191src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019192 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19193 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19194 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19195 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19196 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019199 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19200 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19201 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19202 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19203 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019205src_port : integer
19206 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019207 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19208 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19209 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19210 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019212src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019213 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019214 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19215 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19216 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019217 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019219src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19220 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19221 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19222 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19223 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019224 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019226src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19227 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19228 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19229 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19230 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19231 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19232 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19233 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19234 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019235
19236 Example :
19237 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19238 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19239 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19240 listen ssh
19241 bind :22
19242 mode tcp
19243 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019244 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019245 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019246 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248srv_id : integer
19249 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19250 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019251 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019252
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019253srv_name : string
19254 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19255 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019256 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019257
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192587.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019260
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019261The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019262closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19263when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19264usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019265future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019266
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001926751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19268 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19269 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19270 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19271 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19272 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19273
19274 Example :
19275 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19276 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19277 # the request.
19278 frontend http-in
19279 bind *:8081
19280 default_backend servers
19281 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19282 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19283
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019284ssl_bc : boolean
19285 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19286 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019287 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19288 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019289
19290ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19291 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019292 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19293 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019294
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019295ssl_bc_alpn : string
19296 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19297 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019298 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019299 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19300 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19301 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19302 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19303 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019304 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19305 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019306
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019307ssl_bc_cipher : string
19308 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019309 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19310 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019311
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019312ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19313 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19314 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19315 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019316 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019317
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019318ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019319 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019320 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19321 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19322 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19323 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019324 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19325 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19326 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19327
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019328ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019329 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019330 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19331 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19332 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019333
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019334ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19335 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19336 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019337 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19338 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019339
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019340ssl_bc_npn : string
19341 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19342 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019343 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019344 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19345 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19346 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19347 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019348 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19349 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019350
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019351ssl_bc_protocol : string
19352 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019353 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19354 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019355
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019356ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019357 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019358 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019359 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19360 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019361
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019362ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19363 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19364 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19365 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019366 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019367
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019368ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19369 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19370 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019371 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19372 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019373
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019374ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19375 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19376 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19377 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019378 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019379
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019380ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19381 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019382 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19383 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019385ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19386 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19387 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19388 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19389 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19390 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019392ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19394 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19395 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19396 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019397
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019398ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019399 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19400 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19401 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019402 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019403 does not support resumed sessions.
19404
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019405ssl_c_der : binary
19406 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19407 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19408 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410ssl_c_err : integer
19411 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19412 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19413 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19414 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19415 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019416
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019417ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019418 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19419 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19420 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19421 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19422 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19423 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19424 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19425 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019426 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19427 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19428 LDAP v3.
19429 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19430 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019432ssl_c_key_alg : string
19433 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19434 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19435 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437ssl_c_notafter : string
19438 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19439 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19440 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019442ssl_c_notbefore : string
19443 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19444 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19445 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019446
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019447ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019448 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19449 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19450 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19451 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19452 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19453 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19454 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19455 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019456 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19457 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19458 LDAP v3.
19459 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19460 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019462ssl_c_serial : binary
19463 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19464 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19465 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019467ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19468 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19469 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19470 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019471 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19472 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19473
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019474 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019475 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19478 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19479 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19480 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482ssl_c_used : boolean
19483 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19484 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486ssl_c_verify : integer
19487 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19488 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19489 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19490 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019492ssl_c_version : integer
19493 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19494 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019495
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019496ssl_f_der : binary
19497 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19498 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19499 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19500
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019501ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019502 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19503 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19504 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19505 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019506 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019507 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19508 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19509 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019510 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19511 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19512 LDAP v3.
19513 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19514 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019516ssl_f_key_alg : string
19517 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19518 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19519 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019521ssl_f_notafter : string
19522 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19523 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19524 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526ssl_f_notbefore : string
19527 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19528 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19529 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019530
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019531ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019532 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19533 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19534 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19535 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19536 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19537 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19538 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19539 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019540 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19541 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19542 LDAP v3.
19543 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19544 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019546ssl_f_serial : binary
19547 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19548 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19549 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019550
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019551ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19552 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19553 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19554 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019556ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19557 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19558 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19559 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561ssl_f_version : integer
19562 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19563 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19564
19565ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019566 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19567 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19568 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570 Example :
19571 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19572 listen http-https
19573 bind :80
19574 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19575 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19576
19577ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19578 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19579 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19580
19581ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019582 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019583 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019584 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019585 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19586 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19587 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19588 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19589 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19590 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019592ssl_fc_cipher : string
19593 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19594 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019595
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019596ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19597 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19598 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019599 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019600 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19601 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19602 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019603
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019604 Example:
19605 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19606 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19607 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19608 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19609 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19610 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19611 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19612 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19613 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19614
19615ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019616 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019617 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019618 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19619 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019620 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19621 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019622
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019623ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019624 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019625 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019626 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019627 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19628 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19629 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19630 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19631 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19632 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019633
19634ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019635 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019636 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19637 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019638
19639ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19640 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19641 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019642 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019643
19644 Example:
19645 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19646 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19647 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19648 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19649 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19650 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19651 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19652 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19653 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19654
19655ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19656 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19657 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019658 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019659 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19660 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19661 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19662
19663 Example:
19664 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19665 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19666 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19667 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19668 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19669 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19670 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19671 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19672 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19673
19674ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19675 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19676 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019677 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019678 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19679 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19680 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19681
19682 Example:
19683 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19684 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19685 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19686 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19687 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19688 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19689 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19690 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19691 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019692
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019693ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19694 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19695 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19696 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19697
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019698ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19699 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19700 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19701 transport layer.
19702 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19703 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19704 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19705 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19706
19707ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19708 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19709 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19710 transport layer.
19711 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19712 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19713 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19714 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19715
19716ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19717 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19718 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19719 transport layer.
19720 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19721 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19722 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19723 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19724
19725ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19726 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19727 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19728 transport layer.
19729 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19730 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19731 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19732 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19733
19734ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19735 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19736 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19737 transport layer.
19738 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19739 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19740 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19741 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19742
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019743ssl_fc_err : integer
19744 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19745 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19746 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19747 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19748 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19749 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19750 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19751 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19752 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19753 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19754 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19755 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19756 codes.
19757
19758ssl_fc_err_str : string
19759 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19760 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19761 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19762 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19763 also "ssl_fc_err".
19764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019765ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019766 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19767 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019768 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19769 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19770 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19771 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019772
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019773ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19774 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19775 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19776 wait until the handshake happened.
19777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019778ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19779 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019780 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19781 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019782 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019783 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019784
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019785ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019786 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019787 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19788 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019790ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019791 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019792 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19794 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19795 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19796 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19797 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19798 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019800ssl_fc_protocol : string
19801 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19802 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019803
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019804ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19805 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19806 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019807 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19808 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019809
19810 Example:
19811 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19812 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19813 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19814 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19815 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19816 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19817 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19818 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19819 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19820
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019821ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019822 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019823 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019824 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019825
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019826ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19827 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19828 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19829 transport layer.
19830 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19831 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19832 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19833 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19834
19835ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19836 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19837 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19838 transport layer.
19839 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19840 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19841 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19842 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19843
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019844ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19845 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19846 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19847 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019849ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19850 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19851 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19852 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19853 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019854
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019855ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19856 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19857 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19858 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19859 BoringSSL.
19860
19861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019862ssl_fc_sni : string
19863 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19864 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019865 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19867 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19868
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019869 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019870 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019871 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019872 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019873 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019875 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19877 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019879ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19880 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19881 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019882
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019883ssl_s_der : binary
19884 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19885 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19886 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19887
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019888ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19889 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19890 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19891 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019892 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019893 does not support resumed sessions.
19894
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019895ssl_s_key_alg : string
19896 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19897 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19898 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19899
19900ssl_s_notafter : string
19901 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19902 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19903 transport layer.
19904
19905ssl_s_notbefore : string
19906 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19907 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19908 transport layer.
19909
19910ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19911 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19912 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19913 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19914 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19915 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19916 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019917 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19918 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019919 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19920 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19921 LDAP v3.
19922 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19923 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19924
19925ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19926 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19927 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19928 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19929 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19930 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19931 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019932 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19933 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019934 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19935 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19936 LDAP v3.
19937 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19938 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19939
19940ssl_s_serial : binary
19941 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19942 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19943 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19944
19945ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19946 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19947 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19948 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19949
19950ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19951 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19952 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19953 layer.
19954
19955ssl_s_version : integer
19956 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19957 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199597.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019960------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019962Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19963sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19964only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19965For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19966be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19967can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19968sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19969for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19970content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019971
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019972Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19973 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019974 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019975 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19976 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19977 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19978 sample expression). So be careful.
19979
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010019980distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
19981 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
19982 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
19983 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
19984 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
19985 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
19986 list of supported tokens.
19987
19988distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
19989 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
19990 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
19991 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
19992 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
19993 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
19994 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
19995 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
19996 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
19997 supported tokens.
19998
19999 Example :
20000 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20001 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20002 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20003 # send large files to the big farm
20004 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020006payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020007 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020008 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20009 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020011payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20012 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020013 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020014 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020016req.len : integer
20017req_len : integer (deprecated)
20018 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20019 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20020 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20021 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20022 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020023 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20025 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020027req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20028 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020029 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20030 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20031 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20032 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020033
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020034 ACL derivatives :
20035 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020037req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20038 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20039 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20040 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20041 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020042
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020043 ACL derivatives :
20044 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020046 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020048req.proto_http : boolean
20049req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20050 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20051 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20052 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20053 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20054 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20055 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20056 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058 Example:
20059 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20060 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20061 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020062 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020064req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20065rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20066 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20067 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20068 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20069 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20070 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20071 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20072 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020074 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20075 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20076 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20077 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20078 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20079 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020081 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020082 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020084 Example :
20085 listen tse-farm
20086 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20087 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20088 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20089 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20090 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20091 persist rdp-cookie
20092 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20093 # This is only useful makes sense if
20094 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20095 stick-table type string size 204800
20096 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20097 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20098 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020100 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020101 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020103req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20104rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20105 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20106 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20107 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20108 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020110 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020111 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020112
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020113req.ssl_alpn : string
20114 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20115 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20116 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20117 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20118 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20119 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020120 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020121
20122 Examples :
20123 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20124 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020125 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020126 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020127 default_backend bk_default
20128
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020129req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20130 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20131 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020132 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20133 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20134 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20135 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20136 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020138req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20139req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20140 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20141 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20142 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20143 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20144 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20145 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20146 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020148req.ssl_sni : string
20149req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20150 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20151 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20152 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20153 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20154 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020155 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20156 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20157 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20158 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20159 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20160 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20161 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20162 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20163 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020165 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020166 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020168 Examples :
20169 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20170 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020171 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020172 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020173 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020174
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020175req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20176 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20177 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20178 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20179 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20180 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20181 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20182 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20183 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20184 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020186req.ssl_ver : integer
20187req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20188 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20189 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20190 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20191 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20192 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20193 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20194 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020195 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020196 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020198 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020199 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020200
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020201res.len : integer
20202 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20203 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20204 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20205 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20206 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020207 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020208 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020209 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020211res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20212 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020213 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020214 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020215 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020216 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020218res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20219 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20220 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20221 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020222 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20223 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020225 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020226
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020227res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20228rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20229 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20230 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20231 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20232 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20233 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20234 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20235 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020237wait_end : boolean
20238 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20239 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020240 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020241 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20242 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020243 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020244 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20245 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020247 Examples :
20248 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20249 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20250 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020252 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20253 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20254 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20255 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20256 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20257 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20258 tcp-request content reject
20259
20260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200202617.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020262--------------------------------------
20263
20264It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20265This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20266data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20267its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20268HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20269content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20270to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20271more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20272response are indexed.
20273
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020274Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20275 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20276 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20277 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20278 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20279 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20280 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020282base : string
20283 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20284 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20285 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20286 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20287 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20288 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20289 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20290 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20291
20292 ACL derivatives :
20293 base : exact string match
20294 base_beg : prefix match
20295 base_dir : subdir match
20296 base_dom : domain match
20297 base_end : suffix match
20298 base_len : length match
20299 base_reg : regex match
20300 base_sub : substring match
20301
20302base32 : integer
20303 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20304 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20305 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020306 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20307 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20308 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020309
20310base32+src : binary
20311 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20312 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20313 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20314 per-URL counters.
20315
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020316baseq : string
20317 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20318 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20319 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20320 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20321
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020322capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20323 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20324 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20325 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20326
20327capture.req.method : string
20328 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20329 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20330 because it's allocated.
20331
20332capture.req.uri : string
20333 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20334 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20335 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20336 allocated.
20337
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020338capture.req.ver : string
20339 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20340 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20341 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20342
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020343capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20344 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20345 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20346 The first entry is an index of 0.
20347 See also: "capture response header"
20348
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020349capture.res.ver : string
20350 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20351 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20352 persistent flag.
20353
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020354req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020355 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20356 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20357 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020358
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020359req.body_param([<name>) : string
20360 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20361 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20362 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20363 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20364 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20365 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20366 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20367 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20368 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20369 given.
20370
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020371req.body_len : integer
20372 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20373 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020374 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20375 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020376
20377req.body_size : integer
20378 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020379 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20380 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020382req.cook([<name>]) : string
20383cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20384 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20385 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20386 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20387 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20388 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20389 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20390 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20391 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20392
20393 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020394 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20395 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20396 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20397 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20398 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20399 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20400 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20401 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020403req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20404cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20405 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20406 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020408req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20409cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20410 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20411 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20412 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20413 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020415cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20416 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20417 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20418 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20419 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020420 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020421 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20422 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20423 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20424 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020426hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20427 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20428 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20429 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20430 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020431 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020433req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020434 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20435 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20436 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20437 with headers such as User-Agent.
20438
20439 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20440 found.
20441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020442 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20443 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20444 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020445 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020447req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20448 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20449 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020450 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20451 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020453req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020454 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20455 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20456 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20457 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20458 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20459 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20460 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20461
20462 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20463 found.
20464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020465 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20466 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20467 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020468 with -1 being the last one.
20469
20470 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20471 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020473 ACL derivatives :
20474 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20475 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20476 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20477 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20478 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20479 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20480 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20481 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20482
20483req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20484hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20485 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20486 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020487 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20488 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20489 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20490
20491 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20492 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20493 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20494
20495 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020496
20497req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20498hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20499 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20500 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20501 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020502 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20503 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20504 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20505 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20506 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020507
20508 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20509
20510 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020511
20512req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20513hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20514 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20515 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20516 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020517
20518 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20519
20520 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020521
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020522req.hdrs : string
20523 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20524 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20525 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20526 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20527
20528req.hdrs_bin : binary
20529 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20530 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20531 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20532 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20533 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20534 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20535
20536 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020537
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020538 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20539 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020541http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20542 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20543 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20544 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20545 basic auth is supported.
20546
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020547http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20548 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20549 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20550 performed on the data sent by the client.
20551 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20552 Authorization one.
20553
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020554http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20555 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20556 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20557 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20558 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020559 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20560 basic auth is supported.
20561
20562 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020563 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20564 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20565 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20566 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020567
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020568http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020569 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20570 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20571 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020572
20573http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020574 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20575 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20576 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020577
20578http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020579 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20580 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20581 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020583http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020584 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20585 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020586 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20587 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020589method : integer + string
20590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20591 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20592 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20593 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20594 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20595 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20596 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020598 ACL derivatives :
20599 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020601 Example :
20602 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20603 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20604 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020606path : string
20607 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20608 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20609 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20610 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20611 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020612 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020613 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020615 ACL derivatives :
20616 path : exact string match
20617 path_beg : prefix match
20618 path_dir : subdir match
20619 path_dom : domain match
20620 path_end : suffix match
20621 path_len : length match
20622 path_reg : regex match
20623 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020624
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020625pathq : string
20626 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20627 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20628 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20629 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20630 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20631 result in both cases.
20632
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020633query : string
20634 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20635 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20636 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20637 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020638 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020639 which stops before the question mark.
20640
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020641req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20642 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20643 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20644 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20645 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020647req.ver : string
20648req_ver : string (deprecated)
20649 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20650 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20651 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020653 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020654 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020655
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020656res.body : binary
20657 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20658 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020659 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20660
20661 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020662
20663res.body_len : integer
20664 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20665 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020666 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20667
20668 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020669
20670res.body_size : integer
20671 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20672 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20673 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20674 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020675 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20676
20677 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020678
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020679res.cache_hit : boolean
20680 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20681 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20682
20683res.cache_name : string
20684 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20685 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20686 empty string.
20687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020688res.comp : boolean
20689 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20690 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20691 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020693res.comp_algo : string
20694 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20695 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20696 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020698res.cook([<name>]) : string
20699scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20700 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20701 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020702 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20703
20704 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020706 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020707 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020709res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20710scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20711 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20712 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020713 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20714
20715 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020717res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20718scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20719 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20720 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020721 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20722
20723 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020725res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020726 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20727 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20728
20729 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20730 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20731
20732 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20733
20734 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020736res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020737 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20738 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20739
20740 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20741 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20742
20743 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020745res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20746shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020747 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20748 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20749
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020750 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020751 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20752
20753 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020755 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020756 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20757 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20758 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20759 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20760 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20761 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20762 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20763 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020764
20765res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20766shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020767 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20768 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20769
20770 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020771 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020772
20773 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020775res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20776shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020777 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20778 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20779
20780 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20781
20782 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020783
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020784res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20785 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20786 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20787 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020788 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20789
20790 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020792res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20793shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020794 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20795 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20796
20797 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20798
20799 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020800
20801res.hdrs : string
20802 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20803 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20804 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020805 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20806
20807 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020808
20809res.hdrs_bin : binary
20810 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20811 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20812 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20813 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20814 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20815 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20816 (length of 0 for both).
20817
20818 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20819
20820 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20821 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020823res.ver : string
20824resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20825 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020826 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20827
20828 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020830 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020831 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020833set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20834 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20835 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020836 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020837 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020839 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20840 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020842status : integer
20843 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20844 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020845 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20846
20847 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020848
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020849unique-id : string
20850 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20851 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20852 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20853 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20854 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20855 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020857url : string
20858 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20859 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20860 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20861 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20862 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20863 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20864 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020866 ACL derivatives :
20867 url : exact string match
20868 url_beg : prefix match
20869 url_dir : subdir match
20870 url_dom : domain match
20871 url_end : suffix match
20872 url_len : length match
20873 url_reg : regex match
20874 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020876url_ip : ip
20877 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20878 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20879 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20880 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020881 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20882 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020884url_port : integer
20885 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020886 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020887
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020888urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20889url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020890 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20891 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020892 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20893 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20894 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20895 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020896 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20897 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020898 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20899 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020901 ACL derivatives :
20902 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20903 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20904 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20905 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20906 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20907 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20908 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20909 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020910
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020912 Example :
20913 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20914 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20915 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20916 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020917
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020918urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020919 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20920 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20921 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020922
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020923url32 : integer
20924 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20925 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20926 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20927 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20928 is an unsigned integer.
20929
20930url32+src : binary
20931 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20932 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20933 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20934
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020935
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200209367.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020937---------------------------------------
20938
20939This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20940used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20941purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20942There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20943or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20944any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20945for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20946
20947internal.htx.data : integer
20948 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20949 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20950
20951internal.htx.free : integer
20952 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20953 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20954
20955internal.htx.free_data : integer
20956 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20957 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20958
20959internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020960 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20961 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20962 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020963
20964internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20965 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20966 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20967
20968internal.htx.size : integer
20969 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20970 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20971
20972internal.htx.used : integer
20973 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20974 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20975 direction.
20976
20977internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20978 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20979 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20980 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20981 of the special value :
20982 * head : The oldest inserted block
20983 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020984 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020985
20986internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20987 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20988 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20989 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20990 integer or one of the special value :
20991 * head : The oldest inserted block
20992 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020993 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020994
20995internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20996 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20997 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20998 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20999 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21000
21001 * head : The oldest inserted block
21002 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021003 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021004
21005internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21006 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21007 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21008 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21009 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21010
21011 * head : The oldest inserted block
21012 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021013 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021014
21015internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21016 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21017 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21018 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21019 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21020
21021 * head : The oldest inserted block
21022 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021023 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021024
21025internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21026 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21027 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21028 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21029 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21030
21031 * head : The oldest inserted block
21032 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021033 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021034
21035internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21036 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21037 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21038 it returns false.
21039
21040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200210417.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021042---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021044Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21045every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021046order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021048ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021049---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21050FALSE always_false never match
21051HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21052HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21053HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021054HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021055HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21056HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21057HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21058HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021059LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021060METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21061METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21062METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21063METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21064METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21065METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21066METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21067METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21068RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21069REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21070TRUE always_true always match
21071WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21072---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021073
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210758. Logging
21076----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021077
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21079provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21080very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21081provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21082state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021083to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021084headers.
21085
21086In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21087about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21088send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21089
21090 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21091 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21092 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21093 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21094 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021095 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021096 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021097
21098The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21099allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21100as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21101while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21102real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21103delay.
21104
21105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211068.1. Log levels
21107---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021108
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021109TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021110source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021111HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21112in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21113track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21114syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21115about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021116
21117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211188.2. Log formats
21119----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021121HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021122and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21123slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21124options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021125
21126 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21127 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21128 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21129 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21130 extents.
21131
21132 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21133 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21134 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21135 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21136 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21137
21138 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21139 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21140 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21141 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21142 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21143
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021144 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21145 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21146 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21147 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21148
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021149 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21150
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021151Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21152specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21153field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21154servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21155always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21156identifier.
21157
21158Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21159 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21160 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21161 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21162 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21163
21164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211658.2.1. Default log format
21166-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021167
21168This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21169as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21170format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21171
21172 Example :
21173 listen www
21174 mode http
21175 log global
21176 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21177
21178 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21179 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21180 (www/HTTP)
21181
21182 Field Format Extract from the example above
21183 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21184 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21185 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21186 4 'to' to
21187 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21188 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21189
21190Detailed fields description :
21191 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21192 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21193 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21194 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21195 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21196 and processed the connection.
21197 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21198
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021199In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21200"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21201connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21202
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021203It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21204will eventually disappear.
21205
21206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212078.2.2. TCP log format
21208---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021209
21210The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21211is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21212information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21213counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21214emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21215environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21216the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21217sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021218specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021219not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21220
21221The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21222exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021223if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021224
21225 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21226 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21227 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
21228
21229A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21230are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231
21232 Example :
21233 frontend fnt
21234 mode tcp
21235 option tcplog
21236 log global
21237 default_backend bck
21238
21239 backend bck
21240 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21241
21242 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21243 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21244 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21245
21246 Field Format Extract from the example above
21247 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21248 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21249 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21250 4 frontend_name fnt
21251 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21252 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21253 7 bytes_read* 212
21254 8 termination_state --
21255 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21256 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21257
21258Detailed fields description :
21259 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021260 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021261 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21262 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021263 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021264 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021265 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021266
21267 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021268 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21269 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21270 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021272 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021273 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21274 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021275 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21276 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21277 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21278 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279
21280 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21281 and processed the connection.
21282
21283 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21284 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21285 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21286 applications.
21287
21288 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21289 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21290 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21291 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21292 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21293
21294 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21295 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21296 See "Timers" below for more details.
21297
21298 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21299 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21300 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21301 "Timers" below for more details.
21302
21303 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021304 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021305 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21306 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21307 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21308 details.
21309
21310 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21311 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21312 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21313 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21314 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21315
21316 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21317 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21318 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21319 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21320 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21321 for more details.
21322
21323 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021324 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021325 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21326 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21327 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021328 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021329
21330 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21331 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21332 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21333 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21334 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21335 caused by a denial of service attack.
21336
21337 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21338 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21339 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21340 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21341 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21342 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21343 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21344 denial of service attack.
21345
21346 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21347 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21348 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21349 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21350 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21351 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21352 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21353 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21354 be processed than on other servers.
21355
21356 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21357 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21358 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21359 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021360 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021361 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21362 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21363 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21364 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21365 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21366 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21367 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21368 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21369
21370 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21371 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21372 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21373 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21374 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21375 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021376 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021377 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21378
21379 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21380 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21381 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21382 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21383 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21384 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021385 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021386 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21387 occurs.
21388
21389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213908.2.3. HTTP log format
21391----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021392
21393The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21394is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21395the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21396are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21397emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21398generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21399"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21400which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021401frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21402is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021403
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021404The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21405exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021406if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021407
21408 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21409 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21410 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21411
21412And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21413this exact string:
21414
21415 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21416 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21417 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21418 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21419
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021420Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21421slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21422with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21423
21424 Example :
21425 frontend http-in
21426 mode http
21427 option httplog
21428 log global
21429 default_backend bck
21430
21431 backend static
21432 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21433
21434 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21435 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21436 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021437 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021438
21439 Field Format Extract from the example above
21440 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21441 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021442 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021443 4 frontend_name http-in
21444 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021445 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021446 7 status_code 200
21447 8 bytes_read* 2750
21448 9 captured_request_cookie -
21449 10 captured_response_cookie -
21450 11 termination_state ----
21451 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21452 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21453 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21454 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21455 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021456
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021457Detailed fields description :
21458 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021459 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021460 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21461 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021462 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021463 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021464 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021465
21466 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021467 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21468 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21469 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021470
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021471 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021472 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021473
21474 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21475 and processed the connection.
21476
21477 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21478 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21479 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21480
21481 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21482 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21483 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21484 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21485 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21486 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21487
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021488 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21489 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21490 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021491 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021492 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21493 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021494 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021495 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021496
21497 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21498 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021499 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021500
21501 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21502 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021503 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21504 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021505
21506 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21507 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21508 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21509 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21510 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021511 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21512 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021513
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021514 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021515 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21516 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21517 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21518 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21519 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21520 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021521 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021522
21523 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021524 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21525 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021526
21527 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21528 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021529 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021530 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21531 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21532 overflowing.
21533
21534 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21535 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21536 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21537 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21538 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21539 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21540 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21541 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21542
21543 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21544 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21545 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21546 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21547 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21548 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21549 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21550 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21551
21552 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21553 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21554 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21555 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21556 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21557 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21558 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21559
21560 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021561 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021562 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21563 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21564 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021565 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021566 system.
21567
21568 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21569 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21570 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21571 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21572 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21573 caused by a denial of service attack.
21574
21575 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21576 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21577 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21578 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21579 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21580 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21581 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21582 denial of service attack.
21583
21584 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21585 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21586 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21587 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21588 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21589 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21590 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21591 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21592 processed than on other servers.
21593
21594 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21595 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21596 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21597 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021598 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021599 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21600 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21601 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21602 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21603 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21604 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21605 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21606 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21607
21608 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21609 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21610 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21611 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21612 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21613 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021614 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021615 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21616
21617 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21618 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21619 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21620 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21621 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21622 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021623 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021624 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21625 occurs.
21626
21627 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21628 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21629 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21630 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21631 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21632 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21633 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21634 cookies" below for more details.
21635
21636 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21637 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21638 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21639 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21640 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21641 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21642 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21643 and cookies" below for more details.
21644
21645 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21646 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21647 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21648 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21649 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21650 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21651 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21652 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21653
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021654
216558.2.4. HTTPS log format
21656----------------------
21657
21658The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21659extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21660information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21661frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21662end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21663matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21664sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21665dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21666"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21667
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021668The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21669exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021670if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021671
21672 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21673 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21674 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21675 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021676 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021677
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021678This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21679appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21680HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021681
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021682 Example :
21683 frontend https-in
21684 mode http
21685 option httpslog
21686 log global
21687 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21688 default_backend bck
21689
21690 backend static
21691 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21692
21693 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21694 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21695 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021696 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21697 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021698
21699 Field Format Extract from the example above
21700 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21701 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21702 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21703 4 frontend_name https-in
21704 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21705 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21706 7 status_code 200
21707 8 bytes_read* 2750
21708 9 captured_request_cookie -
21709 10 captured_response_cookie -
21710 11 termination_state ----
21711 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21712 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21713 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21714 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21715 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021716 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021717 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021718 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21719 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021720
21721Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021722 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21723 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21724 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021725
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021726 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21727 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21728 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021729 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021730 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021731
21732 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21733 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21734 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21735 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21736
21737 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21738 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21739 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21740 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21741
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021742 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21743 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21744 can be shared by multiple requests.
21745
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021746 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21747 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21748 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21749 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21750 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21751
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021752 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21753
21754 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21755
21756
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100217578.2.5. Error log format
21758-----------------------
21759
21760When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21761protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21762unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21763line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21764"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21765will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21766logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21767
21768The default format looks like this :
21769
21770 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21771 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21772 Connection error during SSL handshake
21773
21774 Field Format Extract from the example above
21775 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21776 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21777 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21778 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21779 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21780
21781These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21782failures.
21783
21784By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21785above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21786defined format.
21787
21788An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21789source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21790number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21791internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21792error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21793the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21794certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21795indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21796indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21797ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21798are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21799would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21800regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21801
21802 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021803 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021804 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21805 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21806
21807
218088.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021809------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021810
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021811When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21812ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21813a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21814formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21815looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21816and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021818HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021819Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21820separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21821prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21822
21823Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21824variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021825("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021826
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021827If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021828as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021829less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21830the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21831
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021832Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21833"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21834delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21835preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021836
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021837Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21838'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21839https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21840such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21841
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021842Flags are :
21843 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021844 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021845 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21846 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021847
21848 Example:
21849
21850 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21851 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21852
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021853 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21854
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021855Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21856
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021857 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021858 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021859 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21860 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21861 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021862 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21863 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21864 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021865 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021866 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021867 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021868 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021869 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021870 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21871 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021872 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021873 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021874 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021875 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021876 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021877 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021878 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021879 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21880 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21881 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21882 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21883 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021884 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021885 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021886 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021887 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021888 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021889 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21890 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021891 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21892 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21893 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021894 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021895 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21896 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021897 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021898 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21899 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21900 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021901 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021902 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021903 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21904 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21905 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21906 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021907 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021908 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021909 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021910 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021911 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021912 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021913 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21914 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21915 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021916 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021917 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21918 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021919 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021920 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21921 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021922 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021923 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021924 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021925 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021926
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021927 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021928
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219308.3. Advanced logging options
21931-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021932
21933Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21934just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21935options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21936for more information about their usage.
21937
21938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219398.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21940------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021941
21942It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021943HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021944commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21945monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21946ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21947
21948 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21949 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21950 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21951 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21952
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021953 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21954 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021955
21956 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21957 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21958 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21959
21960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21962----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021963
21964The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21965what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21966or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021967"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021968just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21969log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21970after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21971is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21972with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21973with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21974
21975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21977------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021978
21979Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21980for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21981"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21982retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21983raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21984a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21985file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21986you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21987"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21988
21989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21991--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021992
21993Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21994multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21995them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21996"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21997logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21998error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21999and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22000too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22001useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22002alternative.
22003
22004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220058.4. Timing events
22006------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022007
22008Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22009reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22010the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22011frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022012mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22013addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22014
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022015Timings events in HTTP mode:
22016
22017 first request 2nd request
22018 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22019 t tr t tr ...
22020 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22021 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22022 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22023 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022024 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022025 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22026
22027Timings events in TCP mode:
22028
22029 TCP session
22030 |<----------------->|
22031 t t
22032 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22033 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22034 |<------ Tt ------->|
22035
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022036 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022037 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022038 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22039 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22040 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022041 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022042 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22043 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22044 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22045 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022047 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22048 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22049 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022050 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22051 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22052 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22053 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22054 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22055 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022056
22057 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22058 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22059 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22060 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22061 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22062 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22063 request typed by hand during a test.
22064
22065 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22066 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022067 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022068 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22069 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22070 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22071 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022072
22073 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22074 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22075 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22076 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22077 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22078
22079 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22080 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22081 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22082 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22083 connection never established.
22084
22085 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22086 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22087 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22088 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22089 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22090 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22091 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22092 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22093 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22094 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22095 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22096
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022097 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22098 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22099 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22100 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22101 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22102 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22103
22104 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22105
22106 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22107 "Ta" can never be negative.
22108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022109 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22110 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022111 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22112 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022113 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022115 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022116
22117 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022118 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22119 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022120
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022121 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22122 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22123 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22124 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22125 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22126 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22127 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22128 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22129
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022130These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22131protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22132that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022133due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22134"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22135that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022136
22137Most common cases :
22138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022139 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22140 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22141 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22142 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22143 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022144 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022145 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22146 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22147 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22148 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22149 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022150 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022151
22152 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22153 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22154 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22155 of ms on remote networks.
22156
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022157 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22158 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22159 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022160
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022161 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22162 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022163 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022164 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22165 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22166 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22167 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22168 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22169 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022170
22171Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22172
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022173 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022174 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022175 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022176
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022177 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022178 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22179 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22180
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022181 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022182 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22183 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22184 flags.
22185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022186 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22187 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022188 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22189 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22190 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22191 the client connection was maintained open.
22192
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022193 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022194 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022195 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022196 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22197
22198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221998.5. Session state at disconnection
22200-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022201
22202TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22203"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
222042-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22205each of which has a special meaning :
22206
22207 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22208 session to terminate :
22209
22210 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22211
22212 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22213 server explicitly refused it.
22214
22215 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22216 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22217 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22218 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022219 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022220
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022221 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022222 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022223
22224 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22225 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22226 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22227 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22228 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22229
22230 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22231 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22232 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22233 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22234 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22235
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022236 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022237 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22238
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022239 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022240 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22241 backup connections when going up.
22242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022243 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022244
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022245 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22246 send or receive data.
22247
22248 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22249 send or receive data.
22250
22251 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22252 with nothing left in the buffers.
22253
22254 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22255
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022256 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022257 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22258
22259 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22260 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22261 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22262 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22263 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22264
22265 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22266 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22267
22268 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22269 server (HTTP only).
22270
22271 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22272
22273 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22274 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22275 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22276
22277 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22278 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22279 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22280
22281 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22282
22283 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22284 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22285
22286 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22287 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22288 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22289
22290 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22291 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022292 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22293 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022294
22295 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22296 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22297 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22298 another server.
22299
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022300 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022301 server.
22302
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022303 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22304 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22305 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22306 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22307
22308 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22309 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22310 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22311 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22312
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022313 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22314 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22315 "use-server" rule).
22316
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022317 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22318
22319 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22320 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22321
22322 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22323
22324 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22325 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22326 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22327
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022328 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22329 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022330 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022331 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22332 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022334 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22335
22336 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22337 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22338
22339 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22340
22341 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22342
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022343The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22344was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022345helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22346starvation, attacks, etc...
22347
22348The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22349alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22350easier finding and understanding.
22351
22352 Flags Reason
22353
22354 -- Normal termination.
22355
22356 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022357 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22358 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022359 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22360
22361 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22362 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022363 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22364 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022365 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22366 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022367
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022368 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22369 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022370 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022371
22372 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22373 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22374 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22375
22376 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22377 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22378 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22379 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22380 the server takes too long to respond.
22381
22382 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22383 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22384 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22385 long a time to respond.
22386
22387 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22388 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22389 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022390 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022391 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22392 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022393
22394 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22395 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22396 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22397 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22398 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022399 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022400 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22401 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22402 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22403 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22404 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22405 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22406 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22407 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022408 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022409 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22410 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22411 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022412
22413 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22414 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022415 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22416 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22417 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22418 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022419
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022420 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022421 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22422
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022423 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022424 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22425 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022426 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022427 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22428 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22429
22430 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22431 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22432 503 or 504 here.
22433
22434 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022435 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022436 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22437 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22438 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22439
22440 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22441 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022442 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022443 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022444 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022445
22446 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22447 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22448 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22449 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22450 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22451 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022452 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022453
22454 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22455 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22456 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22457 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22458 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22459 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22460 solution is to fix the application.
22461
22462 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22463 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22464 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22465 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22466 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22467 external attacks.
22468
22469 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022470 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022471 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022472 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22473 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22474
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022475 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22476 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22477 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022478 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022479 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022480
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022481 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22482 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22483 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22484 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022485 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22486 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22487 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22488 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022489 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
22490 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
22491 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
22492 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022493
22494 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22495 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22496 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022497 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
22498 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
22499 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
22500 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022501
22502 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22503 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22504 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22505 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22506
22507 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22508 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22509 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22510 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22511
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022512The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022513persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022514important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22515re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22516
22517 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22518
22519 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22520 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22521 set on a GET request.
22522
22523 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22524 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022525 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022526 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22527
22528 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22529 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22530 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22531
22532 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22533 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22534 already got a cookie.
22535
22536 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22537 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22538 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22539 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22540 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22541
22542 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22543 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22544 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22545
22546 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22547 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22548 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22549
22550 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22551 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22552
22553 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22554 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22555 then advertised in the response.
22556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225588.6. Non-printable characters
22559-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022560
22561In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22562consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22563converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22564prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22565being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22566escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22567is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22568'}' when logging headers.
22569
22570Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22571issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22572containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22573
22574Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22575the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22576performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22577
22578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225798.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22580---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022581
22582Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22583achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022584section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022585cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22586the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22587the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022588locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022589not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22590user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22591a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22592wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22593
22594 Examples :
22595 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22596 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22597
22598 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22599 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22600
22601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22603---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022604
22605Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22606proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22607the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22608server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22609
22610Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22611response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022612section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022613
22614It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022615time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22616appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022617are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22618and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22619follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22620request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22621in the logs.
22622
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022623As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22624frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22625an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22626
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022627 Example :
22628 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22629 listen proxy-out
22630 mode http
22631 option httplog
22632 option logasap
22633 log global
22634 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22635
22636 # log the name of the virtual server
22637 capture request header Host len 20
22638
22639 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22640 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22641
22642 # log the beginning of the referrer
22643 capture request header Referer len 20
22644
22645 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22646 capture response header Server len 20
22647
22648 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22649 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22650
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022651 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022652 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22653
22654 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22655 capture response header Via len 20
22656
22657 # log the URL location during a redirection
22658 capture response header Location len 20
22659
22660 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22661 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22662 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22663 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22664 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22665
22666 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22667 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22668 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22669 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022670 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022671
22672 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22673 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22674 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22675 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22676 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022677 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022678
22679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226808.9. Examples of logs
22681---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022682
22683These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22684them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22685reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22686
22687 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22688 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22689 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22690
22691 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22692 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22693
22694 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22695 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22696 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22697
22698 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22699 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22700
22701 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22702 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22703 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22704
22705 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022706 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022707 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22708 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22709
22710 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22711 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22712 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22713
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022714 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22715 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22716 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22717 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022718 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022719 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022720
22721 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022722 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022723
22724 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22725 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22726 Nothing was sent to any server.
22727
22728 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22729 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22730
22731 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22732 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022733 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022734 send a 408 return code to the client.
22735
22736 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22737 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22738
22739 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22740 5 seconds ("c----").
22741
22742 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22743 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022744 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022745
22746 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022747 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022748 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22749 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22750 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22751 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22752 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022753
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022754
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200227559. Supported filters
22756--------------------
22757
22758Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22759accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22760unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22761
22762See also : "filter"
22763
227649.1. Trace
22765----------
22766
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022767filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022768
22769 Arguments:
22770 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22771 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22772
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022773 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022774
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022775 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022776 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22777 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22778 amount of the parsed data.
22779
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022780 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022781
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022782This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22783callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22784information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22785filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22786
22787Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22788tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22789a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22790
22791
227929.2. HTTP compression
22793---------------------
22794
22795filter compression
22796
22797The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22798keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022799when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22800fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22801done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22802explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22803filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22804listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22805order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022806
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022807See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22808 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022809
22810
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200228119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22812--------------------------------------------
22813
22814filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22815
22816 Arguments :
22817
22818 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22819 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22820 parsed.
22821
22822 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22823 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22824 part must be placed in its own scope.
22825
22826The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22827external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022828streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022829exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22830also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22831
22832SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22833the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22834
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022835For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022836"doc/SPOE.txt".
22837
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100228389.4. Cache
22839----------
22840
22841filter cache <name>
22842
22843 Arguments :
22844
22845 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22846
22847The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22848"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022849cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022850other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22851case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22852is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22853filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022854listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22855order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022856
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022857See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22858 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22859
22860
228619.5. Fcgi-app
22862-------------
22863
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022864filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022865
22866 Arguments :
22867
22868 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22869
22870The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22871request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22872reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22873used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22874implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22875used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22876fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22877used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22878order.
22879
22880See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22881 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22882
22883
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100228849.6. OpenTracing
22885----------------
22886
22887The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22888HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22889of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22890Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22891
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022892This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022893
22894The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22895HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22896participates in the work of HAProxy.
22897
22898filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22899
22900 Arguments :
22901
22902 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22903 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22904 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22905 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22906 OpenTracing filters.
22907
22908 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22909 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22910 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22911 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22912 filter must have its own scope defined.
22913
22914More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022915of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022916
22917
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002291810. FastCGI applications
22919-------------------------
22920
22921HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22922feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22923the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22924FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22925servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22926FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22927backend.
22928
22929HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22930application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22931connection.
22932
2293310.1. Setup
22934-----------
22935
2293610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22937--------------------------
22938
22939fcgi-app <name>
22940 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22941 document root must be defined.
22942
22943acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22944 Declare or complete an access list.
22945
22946 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22947 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22948 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22949 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22950 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22951
22952docroot <path>
22953 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22954 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22955 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22956
22957index <script-name>
22958 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22959 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22960 is an optional setting.
22961
22962 Example :
22963 index index.php
22964
22965log-stderr global
22966log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022967 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022968 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22969
22970 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22971 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22972
22973pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22974 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22975 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22976 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22977
22978 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22979 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22980 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22981 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22982
22983 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22984 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22985
22986path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022987 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022988 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22989 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22990 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22991 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22992 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22993 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22994 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022995
22996 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022997 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022998 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22999 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
23000 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
23001 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023002
23003 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023004 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
23005 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023006
23007option get-values
23008no option get-values
23009 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
23010
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023011 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023012 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
23013
23014 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
23015 application will accept.
23016
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020023017 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
23018 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023019
23020 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050023021 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023022 option is disabled.
23023
23024 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
23025 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
23026 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
23027 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
23028 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
23029 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
23030
23031option keep-conn
23032no option keep-conn
23033 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
23034 sending a response.
23035
23036 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
23037 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
23038
23039option max-reqs <reqs>
23040 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
23041 accept.
23042
23043 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
23044 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
23045 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
23046 to 1.
23047
23048option mpxs-conns
23049no option mpxs-conns
23050 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
23051
23052 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
23053 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
23054
23055set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23056 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
23057 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
23058 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
23059 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23060
23061 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
23062 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
23063 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
23064
23065 Example :
23066 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
23067 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
23068
23069 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
23070
23071
2307210.1.2. Proxy section
23073---------------------
23074
23075use-fcgi-app <name>
23076 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
23077
23078 Arguments :
23079 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
23080
23081 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
23082 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
23083 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
23084 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
23085 application may be defined at a time per backend.
23086
23087 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
23088 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
23089 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
23090 application are evaluated.
23091
23092
2309310.1.3. Example
23094---------------
23095
23096 frontend front-http
23097 mode http
23098 bind *:80
23099 bind *:
23100
23101 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
23102 default_backend back-static
23103
23104 backend back-static
23105 mode http
23106 server www A.B.C.D:80
23107
23108 backend back-dynamic
23109 mode http
23110 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23111 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23112
23113 fcgi-app php-fpm
23114 log-stderr global
23115 option keep-conn
23116
23117 docroot /var/www/my-app
23118 index index.php
23119 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23120
23121
2312210.2. Default parameters
23123------------------------
23124
23125A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23126the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023127script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023128applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23129
23130 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23131 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23132 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23133 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23134 | | |
23135 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23136 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23137 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23138 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23139 | | application. |
23140 | | |
23141 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23142 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23143 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23144 | | |
23145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23146 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23147 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23148 | | the application's configuration. |
23149 | | |
23150 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23151 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23152 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23153 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23154 | | |
23155 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23156 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23157 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23158 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23159 | | be defined. |
23160 | | |
23161 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23162 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23163 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23164 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23165 | | is not set too. |
23166 | | |
23167 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23168 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23169 | | set. |
23170 | | |
23171 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23172 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23173 | | the request. |
23174 | | |
23175 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23176 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23177 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23178 | | |
23179 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23180 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23181 | | script to process the request. |
23182 | | |
23183 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23184 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23185 | | |
23186 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23187 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23188 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23189 | | |
23190 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23191 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23192 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23193 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23194 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23195 | | |
23196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23197 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23198 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23199 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23200 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23201 | | side. |
23202 | | |
23203 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23204 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23205 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23206 | | connected to. |
23207 | | |
23208 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23209 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23210 | | |
23211 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023212 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23213 | | current HAProxy version. |
23214 | | |
23215 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023216 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23217 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23218 | | |
23219 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23220
23221
2322210.3. Limitations
23223------------------
23224
23225The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23226way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23227during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23228establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23229application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23230or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23231message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23232these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23233and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23234
23235Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23236request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23237requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23238
23239About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23240into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23241fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23242"http-request" ones.
23243
23244Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23245FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23246processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23247must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23248here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023249
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023250
2325111. Address formats
23252-------------------
23253
23254Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23255address.
23256
23257This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23258The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23259of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23260equivalent is '::'.
23261
23262Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23263is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23264
23265This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23266family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23267
23268Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23269configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23270use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23271'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23272
23273Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23274socket type and the transport method.
23275
23276
2327711.1 Address family prefixes
23278----------------------------
23279
23280'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23281
23282'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23283 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23284 listening.
23285
23286'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23287 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23288 on the statement using this address, a port or
23289 a port range may or must be specified.
23290
23291'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23292 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23293 using this address, a port or a port range
23294 may or must be specified.
23295
23296'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23297 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23298 using this address, a port or a port range
23299 may or must be specified.
23300
23301'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23302 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23303 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23304 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23305 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23306 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23307
23308'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23309 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23310 start by slash '/'.
23311
23312
2331311.2 Socket type prefixes
23314-------------------------
23315
23316Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23317type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23318this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23319This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23320but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23321
23322Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23323instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23324
23325If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23326they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23327report this to the maintainers.
23328
23329'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23330 to "stream"
23331
23332'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23333 to "datagram".
23334
23335
2333611.3 Protocol prefixes
23337----------------------
23338
23339'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23340 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23341 socket type and transport method is forced to
23342 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23343 this address, a port or a port range can or
23344 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23345 of 'stream+ip@'.
23346
23347'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23348 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23349 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23350 statement using this address, a port or port
23351 range can or must be specified.
23352 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23353
23354'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23355 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23356 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23357 statement using this address, a port or port
23358 range can or must be specified.
23359 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23360
23361'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23362 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23363 socket type and transport method is forced to
23364 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23365 this address, a port or a port range can or
23366 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23367 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23368
23369'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23370 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23371 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23372 the statement using this address, a port or
23373 port range can or must be specified.
23374 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23375
23376'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23377 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23378 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23379 the statement using this address, a port or
23380 port range can or must be specified.
23381 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23382
23383'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23384 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23385 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23386
23387'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23388 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23389 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23390
23391In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23392QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023394/*
23395 * Local variables:
23396 * fill-column: 79
23397 * End:
23398 */